xref: /openbmc/linux/include/net/mac80211.h (revision 9144f784f852f9a125cabe9927b986d909bfa439)
1  /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2  /*
3   * mac80211 <-> driver interface
4   *
5   * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc.
6   * Copyright 2006-2007	Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz>
7   * Copyright 2007-2010	Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
8   * Copyright 2013-2014  Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9   * Copyright (C) 2015 - 2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH
10   * Copyright (C) 2018 - 2023 Intel Corporation
11   */
12  
13  #ifndef MAC80211_H
14  #define MAC80211_H
15  
16  #include <linux/bug.h>
17  #include <linux/kernel.h>
18  #include <linux/if_ether.h>
19  #include <linux/skbuff.h>
20  #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
21  #include <linux/lockdep.h>
22  #include <net/cfg80211.h>
23  #include <net/codel.h>
24  #include <net/ieee80211_radiotap.h>
25  #include <asm/unaligned.h>
26  
27  /**
28   * DOC: Introduction
29   *
30   * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements
31   * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document
32   * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware
33   * drivers.
34   */
35  
36  /**
37   * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts
38   *
39   * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be
40   * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any
41   * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such
42   * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the
43   * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even
44   * tasklet function.
45   *
46   * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also
47   *	 use the non-IRQ-safe functions!
48   */
49  
50  /**
51   * DOC: Warning
52   *
53   * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will
54   * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet.
55   */
56  
57  /**
58   * DOC: Frame format
59   *
60   * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver,
61   * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are
62   * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the
63   * hardware.
64   *
65   * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features:
66   *
67   * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload
68   * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware.
69   *
70   * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to
71   * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU.
72   */
73  
74  /**
75   * DOC: mac80211 workqueue
76   *
77   * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use.
78   * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by
79   * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the
80   * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback.
81   *
82   * mac80211 will flushed the workqueue upon interface removal and during
83   * suspend.
84   *
85   * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock.
86   *
87   */
88  
89  /**
90   * DOC: mac80211 software tx queueing
91   *
92   * mac80211 uses an intermediate queueing implementation, designed to allow the
93   * driver to keep hardware queues short and to provide some fairness between
94   * different stations/interfaces.
95   *
96   * Drivers must provide the .wake_tx_queue driver operation by either
97   * linking it to ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() or implementing a custom
98   * handler.
99   *
100   * Intermediate queues (struct ieee80211_txq) are kept per-sta per-tid, with
101   * another per-sta for non-data/non-mgmt and bufferable management frames, and
102   * a single per-vif queue for multicast data frames.
103   *
104   * The driver is expected to initialize its private per-queue data for stations
105   * and interfaces in the .add_interface and .sta_add ops.
106   *
107   * The driver can't access the internal TX queues (iTXQs) directly.
108   * Whenever mac80211 adds a new frame to a queue, it calls the .wake_tx_queue
109   * driver op.
110   * Drivers implementing a custom .wake_tx_queue op can get them by calling
111   * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). Drivers using ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() will
112   * simply get the individual frames pushed via the .tx driver operation.
113   *
114   * Drivers can optionally delegate responsibility for scheduling queues to
115   * mac80211, to take advantage of airtime fairness accounting. In this case, to
116   * obtain the next queue to pull frames from, the driver calls
117   * ieee80211_next_txq(). The driver is then expected to return the txq using
118   * ieee80211_return_txq().
119   *
120   * For AP powersave TIM handling, the driver only needs to indicate if it has
121   * buffered packets in the driver specific data structures by calling
122   * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(). For frames buffered in the ieee80211_txq
123   * struct, mac80211 sets the appropriate TIM PVB bits and calls
124   * .release_buffered_frames().
125   * In that callback the driver is therefore expected to release its own
126   * buffered frames and afterwards also frames from the ieee80211_txq (obtained
127   * via the usual ieee80211_tx_dequeue).
128   */
129  
130  /**
131   * DOC: HW timestamping
132   *
133   * Timing Measurement and Fine Timing Measurement require accurate timestamps
134   * of the action frames TX/RX and their respective acks.
135   *
136   * To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine Timing
137   * Measurement frame RX, the low level driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp
138   * field to the frame RX timestamp and report the ack TX timestamp in the
139   * ieee80211_rx_status struct.
140   *
141   * Similarly, To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine
142   * Timing Measurement frame TX, the driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp field
143   * to the frame TX timestamp and report the ack RX timestamp in the
144   * ieee80211_tx_status struct.
145   */
146  struct device;
147  
148  /**
149   * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues
150   *
151   * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues.
152   * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set
153   */
154  enum ieee80211_max_queues {
155  	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES =		16,
156  	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP =	BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1,
157  };
158  
159  #define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE	0xff
160  
161  /**
162   * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211
163   * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice
164   * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video
165   * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort
166   * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background
167   */
168  enum ieee80211_ac_numbers {
169  	IEEE80211_AC_VO		= 0,
170  	IEEE80211_AC_VI		= 1,
171  	IEEE80211_AC_BE		= 2,
172  	IEEE80211_AC_BK		= 3,
173  };
174  
175  /**
176   * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration
177   *
178   * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS
179   * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29.
180   *
181   * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255]
182   * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form
183   *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
184   * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min]
185   * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
186   * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category
187   * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue
188   * @mu_edca: is the MU EDCA configured
189   * @mu_edca_param_rec: MU EDCA Parameter Record for HE
190   */
191  struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params {
192  	u16 txop;
193  	u16 cw_min;
194  	u16 cw_max;
195  	u8 aifs;
196  	bool acm;
197  	bool uapsd;
198  	bool mu_edca;
199  	struct ieee80211_he_mu_edca_param_ac_rec mu_edca_param_rec;
200  };
201  
202  struct ieee80211_low_level_stats {
203  	unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount;
204  	unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount;
205  	unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount;
206  	unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount;
207  };
208  
209  /**
210   * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context
211   * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed
212   * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed
213   * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed
214   * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel,
215   *	this is used only with channel switching with CSA
216   * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH: The min required channel width changed
217   */
218  enum ieee80211_chanctx_change {
219  	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH		= BIT(0),
220  	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS	= BIT(1),
221  	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR		= BIT(2),
222  	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL	= BIT(3),
223  	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH	= BIT(4),
224  };
225  
226  /**
227   * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to
228   *
229   * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx
230   * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only.
231   *
232   * @def: the channel definition
233   * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required.
234   * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be
235   *	active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions
236   * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled
237   *	after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions;
238   *	this will always be >= @rx_chains_static.
239   * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel.
240   * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
241   *	sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information.
242   */
243  struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf {
244  	struct cfg80211_chan_def def;
245  	struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def;
246  
247  	u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic;
248  
249  	bool radar_enabled;
250  
251  	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
252  };
253  
254  /**
255   * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode
256   * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already
257   *	exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface
258   *	needs to be switched from one to the other.
259   * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop
260   *      to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but
261   *      will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches
262   *      from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course
263   *      implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing
264   *      hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context
265   *      will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used
266   *      for changes/removal.)
267   */
268  enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode {
269  	CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF,
270  	CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS,
271  };
272  
273  /**
274   * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information
275   *
276   * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that
277   * needs to switch from one chanctx to another.  The
278   * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be
279   * done.
280   *
281   * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx
282   * @link_conf: the link conf that's switching
283   * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned
284   * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned
285   */
286  struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch {
287  	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
288  	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf;
289  	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx;
290  	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx;
291  };
292  
293  /**
294   * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags
295   *
296   * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed(), link_info_changed()
297   * and vif_cfg_changed() callbacks to indicate which parameter(s) changed.
298   *
299   * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated),
300   *	also implies a change in the AID.
301   * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed
302   * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed
303   * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed
304   * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed
305   * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed
306   * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed
307   * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever
308   *	reason (IBSS and managed mode)
309   * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve
310   *	new beacon (beaconing modes)
311   * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be
312   *	enabled/disabled (beaconing modes)
313   * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed
314   * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed
315   * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed.
316   * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note
317   *	that it is only ever disabled for station mode.
318   * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface.
319   * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode)
320   * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode)
321   * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode)
322   * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface
323   * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS)
324   *	changed
325   * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available:
326   *	currently dtim_period only is under consideration.
327   * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed,
328   *	note that this is only called when it changes after the channel
329   *	context had been assigned.
330   * @BSS_CHANGED_OCB: OCB join status changed
331   * @BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS: VHT MU-MIMO group id or user position changed
332   * @BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE: keep alive options (idle period or protected
333   *	keep alive) changed.
334   * @BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE: Multicast Rate setting changed for this interface
335   * @BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER: fine timing measurement request responder
336   *	functionality changed for this BSS (AP mode).
337   * @BSS_CHANGED_TWT: TWT status changed
338   * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD: OBSS Packet Detection status changed.
339   * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR: BSS Color has changed
340   * @BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY: FILS discovery status changed.
341   * @BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
342   *	status changed.
343   * @BSS_CHANGED_EHT_PUNCTURING: The channel puncturing bitmap changed.
344   */
345  enum ieee80211_bss_change {
346  	BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC		= 1<<0,
347  	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT	= 1<<1,
348  	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE	= 1<<2,
349  	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT		= 1<<3,
350  	BSS_CHANGED_HT			= 1<<4,
351  	BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES		= 1<<5,
352  	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT		= 1<<6,
353  	BSS_CHANGED_BSSID		= 1<<7,
354  	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON		= 1<<8,
355  	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED	= 1<<9,
356  	BSS_CHANGED_CQM			= 1<<10,
357  	BSS_CHANGED_IBSS		= 1<<11,
358  	BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER		= 1<<12,
359  	BSS_CHANGED_QOS			= 1<<13,
360  	BSS_CHANGED_IDLE		= 1<<14,
361  	BSS_CHANGED_SSID		= 1<<15,
362  	BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP	= 1<<16,
363  	BSS_CHANGED_PS			= 1<<17,
364  	BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER		= 1<<18,
365  	BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS		= 1<<19,
366  	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO		= 1<<20,
367  	BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH		= 1<<21,
368  	BSS_CHANGED_OCB                 = 1<<22,
369  	BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS		= 1<<23,
370  	BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE		= 1<<24,
371  	BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE		= 1<<25,
372  	BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER	= 1<<26,
373  	BSS_CHANGED_TWT			= 1<<27,
374  	BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD		= 1<<28,
375  	BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR	= 1<<29,
376  	BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY      = 1<<30,
377  	BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP = 1<<31,
378  	BSS_CHANGED_EHT_PUNCTURING	= BIT_ULL(32),
379  
380  	/* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */
381  };
382  
383  /*
384   * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number
385   * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP
386   * filtering will be disabled.
387   */
388  #define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4
389  
390  /**
391   * enum ieee80211_event_type - event to be notified to the low level driver
392   * @RSSI_EVENT: AP's rssi crossed the a threshold set by the driver.
393   * @MLME_EVENT: event related to MLME
394   * @BAR_RX_EVENT: a BAR was received
395   * @BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT: Frames were released from the reordering buffer because
396   *	they timed out. This won't be called for each frame released, but only
397   *	once each time the timeout triggers.
398   */
399  enum ieee80211_event_type {
400  	RSSI_EVENT,
401  	MLME_EVENT,
402  	BAR_RX_EVENT,
403  	BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT,
404  };
405  
406  /**
407   * enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data - relevant when event type is %RSSI_EVENT
408   * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi went below the threshold set by the driver.
409   * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi went above the threshold set by the driver.
410   */
411  enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data {
412  	RSSI_EVENT_HIGH,
413  	RSSI_EVENT_LOW,
414  };
415  
416  /**
417   * struct ieee80211_rssi_event - data attached to an %RSSI_EVENT
418   * @data: See &enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data
419   */
420  struct ieee80211_rssi_event {
421  	enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data data;
422  };
423  
424  /**
425   * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
426   * @AUTH_EVENT: the MLME operation is authentication
427   * @ASSOC_EVENT: the MLME operation is association
428   * @DEAUTH_RX_EVENT: deauth received..
429   * @DEAUTH_TX_EVENT: deauth sent.
430   */
431  enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data {
432  	AUTH_EVENT,
433  	ASSOC_EVENT,
434  	DEAUTH_RX_EVENT,
435  	DEAUTH_TX_EVENT,
436  };
437  
438  /**
439   * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
440   * @MLME_SUCCESS: the MLME operation completed successfully.
441   * @MLME_DENIED: the MLME operation was denied by the peer.
442   * @MLME_TIMEOUT: the MLME operation timed out.
443   */
444  enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status {
445  	MLME_SUCCESS,
446  	MLME_DENIED,
447  	MLME_TIMEOUT,
448  };
449  
450  /**
451   * struct ieee80211_mlme_event - data attached to an %MLME_EVENT
452   * @data: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data
453   * @status: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status
454   * @reason: the reason code if applicable
455   */
456  struct ieee80211_mlme_event {
457  	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data data;
458  	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status status;
459  	u16 reason;
460  };
461  
462  /**
463   * struct ieee80211_ba_event - data attached for BlockAck related events
464   * @sta: pointer to the &ieee80211_sta to which this event relates
465   * @tid: the tid
466   * @ssn: the starting sequence number (for %BAR_RX_EVENT)
467   */
468  struct ieee80211_ba_event {
469  	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
470  	u16 tid;
471  	u16 ssn;
472  };
473  
474  /**
475   * struct ieee80211_event - event to be sent to the driver
476   * @type: The event itself. See &enum ieee80211_event_type.
477   * @rssi: relevant if &type is %RSSI_EVENT
478   * @mlme: relevant if &type is %AUTH_EVENT
479   * @ba: relevant if &type is %BAR_RX_EVENT or %BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT
480   * @u:union holding the fields above
481   */
482  struct ieee80211_event {
483  	enum ieee80211_event_type type;
484  	union {
485  		struct ieee80211_rssi_event rssi;
486  		struct ieee80211_mlme_event mlme;
487  		struct ieee80211_ba_event ba;
488  	} u;
489  };
490  
491  /**
492   * struct ieee80211_mu_group_data - STA's VHT MU-MIMO group data
493   *
494   * This structure describes the group id data of VHT MU-MIMO
495   *
496   * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
497   * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
498   */
499  struct ieee80211_mu_group_data {
500  	u8 membership[WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN];
501  	u8 position[WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN];
502  };
503  
504  /**
505   * struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params - FTM responder parameters
506   *
507   * @lci: LCI subelement content
508   * @civicloc: CIVIC location subelement content
509   * @lci_len: LCI data length
510   * @civicloc_len: Civic data length
511   */
512  struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params {
513  	const u8 *lci;
514  	const u8 *civicloc;
515  	size_t lci_len;
516  	size_t civicloc_len;
517  };
518  
519  /**
520   * struct ieee80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
521   * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
522   *
523   * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
524   * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
525   */
526  struct ieee80211_fils_discovery {
527  	u32 min_interval;
528  	u32 max_interval;
529  };
530  
531  /**
532   * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters
533   *
534   * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association
535   * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS.
536   *
537   * @vif: reference to owning VIF
538   * @addr: (link) address used locally
539   * @link_id: link ID, or 0 for non-MLO
540   * @htc_trig_based_pkt_ext: default PE in 4us units, if BSS supports HE
541   * @uora_exists: is the UORA element advertised by AP
542   * @ack_enabled: indicates support to receive a multi-TID that solicits either
543   *	ACK, BACK or both
544   * @uora_ocw_range: UORA element's OCW Range field
545   * @frame_time_rts_th: HE duration RTS threshold, in units of 32us
546   * @he_support: does this BSS support HE
547   * @twt_requester: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
548   *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
549   * @twt_responder: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
550   *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
551   * @twt_protected: does this BSS support protected TWT frames
552   * @twt_broadcast: does this BSS support broadcast TWT
553   * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection
554   * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble
555   * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP)
556   * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing,
557   *	valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified
558   *	with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then.
559   * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old
560   *	as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the
561   *	HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can
562   *	only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after
563   *	association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the
564   *	%BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
565   * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf,
566   *	the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation
567   *	(see @sync_tsf). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
568   * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY
569   *	is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts.
570   *	IMPORTANT: These three sync_* parameters would possibly be out of sync
571   *	by the time the driver will use them. The synchronized view is currently
572   *	guaranteed only in certain callbacks.
573   *	Note also that this is not used with MLD associations, mac80211 doesn't
574   *	know how to track beacons for all of the links for this.
575   * @beacon_int: beacon interval
576   * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp
577   * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an
578   *	index into the rate table configured by the driver in
579   *	the current band.
580   * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate
581   * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
582   * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS
583   * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not
584   * @chandef: Channel definition for this BSS -- the hardware might be
585   *	configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example.
586   * @mu_group: VHT MU-MIMO group membership data
587   * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation.
588   *	This field is only valid when the channel is a wide HT/VHT channel.
589   *	Note that with TDLS this can be the case (channel is HT, protection must
590   *	be used from this field) even when the BSS association isn't using HT.
591   * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value
592   *	implies disabled. As with the cfg80211 callback, a change here should
593   *	cause an event to be sent indicating where the current value is in
594   *	relation to the newly configured threshold.
595   * @cqm_rssi_low: Connection quality monitor RSSI lower threshold, a zero value
596   *	implies disabled.  This is an alternative mechanism to the single
597   *	threshold event and can't be enabled simultaneously with it.
598   * @cqm_rssi_high: Connection quality monitor RSSI upper threshold.
599   * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis
600   * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS.
601   * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode.
602   * @txpower: TX power in dBm.  INT_MIN means not configured.
603   * @txpower_type: TX power adjustment used to control per packet Transmit
604   *	Power Control (TPC) in lower driver for the current vif. In particular
605   *	TPC is enabled if value passed in %txpower_type is
606   *	NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED (allow using less than specified from
607   *	userspace), whereas TPC is disabled if %txpower_type is set to
608   *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED (use value configured from userspace)
609   * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave
610   * @allow_p2p_go_ps: indication for AP or P2P GO interface, whether it's allowed
611   *	to use P2P PS mechanism or not. AP/P2P GO is not allowed to use P2P PS
612   *	if it has associated clients without P2P PS support.
613   * @max_idle_period: the time period during which the station can refrain from
614   *	transmitting frames to its associated AP without being disassociated.
615   *	In units of 1000 TUs. Zero value indicates that the AP did not include
616   *	a (valid) BSS Max Idle Period Element.
617   * @protected_keep_alive: if set, indicates that the station should send an RSN
618   *	protected frame to the AP to reset the idle timer at the AP for the
619   *	station.
620   * @ftm_responder: whether to enable or disable fine timing measurement FTM
621   *	responder functionality.
622   * @ftmr_params: configurable lci/civic parameter when enabling FTM responder.
623   * @nontransmitted: this BSS is a nontransmitted BSS profile
624   * @transmitter_bssid: the address of transmitter AP
625   * @bssid_index: index inside the multiple BSSID set
626   * @bssid_indicator: 2^bssid_indicator is the maximum number of APs in set
627   * @ema_ap: AP supports enhancements of discovery and advertisement of
628   *	nontransmitted BSSIDs
629   * @profile_periodicity: the least number of beacon frames need to be received
630   *	in order to discover all the nontransmitted BSSIDs in the set.
631   * @he_oper: HE operation information of the BSS (AP/Mesh) or of the AP we are
632   *	connected to (STA)
633   * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection parameters.
634   * @he_bss_color: BSS coloring settings, if BSS supports HE
635   * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery configuration
636   * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
637   *	interval.
638   * @beacon_tx_rate: The configured beacon transmit rate that needs to be passed
639   *	to driver when rate control is offloaded to firmware.
640   * @power_type: power type of BSS for 6 GHz
641   * @tx_pwr_env: transmit power envelope array of BSS.
642   * @tx_pwr_env_num: number of @tx_pwr_env.
643   * @pwr_reduction: power constraint of BSS.
644   * @eht_support: does this BSS support EHT
645   * @eht_puncturing: bitmap to indicate which channels are punctured in this BSS
646   * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on. Internally it is
647   *	write-protected by sdata_lock and local->mtx so holding either is fine
648   *	for read access.
649   * @csa_punct_bitmap: new puncturing bitmap for channel switch
650   * @mu_mimo_owner: indicates interface owns MU-MIMO capability
651   * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL
652   *	when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX
653   *	path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always
654   *	be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be
655   *	processed after it switches back to %NULL.
656   * @color_change_active: marks whether a color change is ongoing. Internally it is
657   *	write-protected by sdata_lock and local->mtx so holding either is fine
658   *	for read access.
659   * @color_change_color: the bss color that will be used after the change.
660   * @ht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HT LDPC capability.
661   * @vht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has VHT LDPC capability.
662   * @he_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HE LDPC capability.
663   * @vht_su_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
664   *	beamformer
665   * @vht_su_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
666   *	beamformee
667   * @vht_mu_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
668   *	beamformer
669   * @vht_mu_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
670   *	beamformee
671   * @he_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
672   *	beamformer
673   * @he_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
674   *	beamformee
675   * @he_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE MU
676   *	beamformer
677   * @he_full_ul_mumimo: does this BSS support the reception (AP) or transmission
678   *	(non-AP STA) of an HE TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU
679   *	bandwidth
680   * @eht_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
681   *	beamformer
682   * @eht_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
683   *	beamformee
684   * @eht_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT MU
685   *	beamformer
686   */
687  struct ieee80211_bss_conf {
688  	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
689  
690  	const u8 *bssid;
691  	unsigned int link_id;
692  	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
693  	u8 htc_trig_based_pkt_ext;
694  	bool uora_exists;
695  	u8 uora_ocw_range;
696  	u16 frame_time_rts_th;
697  	bool he_support;
698  	bool twt_requester;
699  	bool twt_responder;
700  	bool twt_protected;
701  	bool twt_broadcast;
702  	/* erp related data */
703  	bool use_cts_prot;
704  	bool use_short_preamble;
705  	bool use_short_slot;
706  	bool enable_beacon;
707  	u8 dtim_period;
708  	u16 beacon_int;
709  	u16 assoc_capability;
710  	u64 sync_tsf;
711  	u32 sync_device_ts;
712  	u8 sync_dtim_count;
713  	u32 basic_rates;
714  	struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate;
715  	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
716  	u16 ht_operation_mode;
717  	s32 cqm_rssi_thold;
718  	u32 cqm_rssi_hyst;
719  	s32 cqm_rssi_low;
720  	s32 cqm_rssi_high;
721  	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
722  	struct ieee80211_mu_group_data mu_group;
723  	bool qos;
724  	bool hidden_ssid;
725  	int txpower;
726  	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting txpower_type;
727  	struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr;
728  	bool allow_p2p_go_ps;
729  	u16 max_idle_period;
730  	bool protected_keep_alive;
731  	bool ftm_responder;
732  	struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params *ftmr_params;
733  	/* Multiple BSSID data */
734  	bool nontransmitted;
735  	u8 transmitter_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
736  	u8 bssid_index;
737  	u8 bssid_indicator;
738  	bool ema_ap;
739  	u8 profile_periodicity;
740  	struct {
741  		u32 params;
742  		u16 nss_set;
743  	} he_oper;
744  	struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
745  	struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
746  	struct ieee80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
747  	u32 unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval;
748  	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_tx_rate;
749  	enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power power_type;
750  	struct ieee80211_tx_pwr_env tx_pwr_env[IEEE80211_TPE_MAX_IE_COUNT];
751  	u8 tx_pwr_env_num;
752  	u8 pwr_reduction;
753  	bool eht_support;
754  	u16 eht_puncturing;
755  
756  	bool csa_active;
757  	u16 csa_punct_bitmap;
758  
759  	bool mu_mimo_owner;
760  	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf;
761  
762  	bool color_change_active;
763  	u8 color_change_color;
764  
765  	bool ht_ldpc;
766  	bool vht_ldpc;
767  	bool he_ldpc;
768  	bool vht_su_beamformer;
769  	bool vht_su_beamformee;
770  	bool vht_mu_beamformer;
771  	bool vht_mu_beamformee;
772  	bool he_su_beamformer;
773  	bool he_su_beamformee;
774  	bool he_mu_beamformer;
775  	bool he_full_ul_mumimo;
776  	bool eht_su_beamformer;
777  	bool eht_su_beamformee;
778  	bool eht_mu_beamformer;
779  };
780  
781  /**
782   * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status
783   *
784   * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info.
785   *
786   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame.
787   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence
788   *	number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment
789   *	number and increasing the sequence number only when the
790   *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly
791   *	assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly
792   *	for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from
793   *	that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing.
794   *	If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to
795   *	assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE
796   *	802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for
797   *	beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field.
798   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack
799   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination
800   *	station
801   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame
802   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon
803   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU
804   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211.
805   * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted
806   *	because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to
807   *	avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or
808   *	firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station
809   *	went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on
810   *	the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for
811   *	that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above),
812   *	since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the
813   *	hardware queue.
814   * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged
815   * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status
816   * 	is for the whole aggregation.
817   * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned,
818   * 	so consider using block ack request (BAR).
819   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be
820   *	set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will
821   *	be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment)
822   * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate
823   *	that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for
824   *	off-channel operation.
825   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP: This frame uses hardware encapsulation
826   *	(header conversion)
827   * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211,
828   *	used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS
829   * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211,
830   *	used to indicate frame should not be encrypted
831   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll
832   *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must
833   *	be sent although the station is in powersave mode.
834   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the
835   *	transmit function after the current frame, this can be used
836   *	by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the
837   *	queue gets full.
838   * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted
839   *	after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not
840   *	be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.)
841   * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME
842   *	code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status
843   *	should kick the MLME state machine.
844   * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211
845   *	MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX
846   *	status to user space)
847   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame
848   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this
849   *	frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use.
850   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on
851   *	the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done
852   *	in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be
853   *	handled properly by the device.
854   * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP
855   *	testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow
856   *	TKIP countermeasures to be tested.
857   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate.
858   *	This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P
859   *	frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band.
860   * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period,
861   *	when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in
862   *	an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames
863   *	the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for
864   *	PS-Poll responses.
865   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate.
866   *	This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when
867   *	the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose.
868   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it
869   *	would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for
870   *	monitor injection).
871   * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED: A frame that was marked with
872   *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK has been successfully transmitted without
873   *	any errors (like issues specific to the driver/HW).
874   *	This flag must not be set for frames that don't request no-ack
875   *	behaviour with IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK.
876   *
877   * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't
878   *	 forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary.
879   */
880  enum mac80211_tx_info_flags {
881  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS		= BIT(0),
882  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ		= BIT(1),
883  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK			= BIT(2),
884  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT		= BIT(3),
885  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT		= BIT(4),
886  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM	= BIT(5),
887  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU			= BIT(6),
888  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED		= BIT(7),
889  	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED		= BIT(8),
890  	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK			= BIT(9),
891  	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU			= BIT(10),
892  	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK		= BIT(11),
893  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE	= BIT(12),
894  	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK	= BIT(13),
895  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP		= BIT(14),
896  	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED		= BIT(15),
897  	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT		= BIT(16),
898  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER		= BIT(17),
899  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES		= BIT(18),
900  	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION	= BIT(19),
901  	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX		= BIT(20),
902  	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX	= BIT(21),
903  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC			= BIT(22),
904  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC			= BIT(23) | BIT(24),
905  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN		= BIT(25),
906  	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE	= BIT(26),
907  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE		= BIT(27),
908  	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP		= BIT(28),
909  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE		= BIT(29),
910  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG		= BIT(30),
911  	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED	= BIT(31),
912  };
913  
914  #define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT		23
915  
916  #define IEEE80211_TX_RC_S1G_MCS IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS
917  
918  /**
919   * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control
920   *
921   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control
922   *	protocol frame (e.g. EAP)
923   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll
924   *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD).
925   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT: This frame is injected with rate information
926   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU: This frame is an A-MSDU frame
927   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT: This frame is going through the fast_xmit path
928   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP: This frame skips mesh path lookup
929   * @IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211,
930   *	used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before
931   *	it can be sent out.
932   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO: Do not overwrite the sequence number that
933   *	has already been assigned to this frame.
934   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER: This frame should not be reordered
935   *	relative to other frames that have this flag set, independent
936   *	of their QoS TID or other priority field values.
937   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX: first MLO TX, used mostly internally
938   *	for sequence number assignment
939   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_USE_RATE_MASK: Don't use rate mask for this frame
940   *	which is transmitted due to scanning or offchannel TX, not in normal
941   *	operation on the interface.
942   * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK: If not @IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, this
943   *	frame should be transmitted on the specific link. This really is
944   *	only relevant for frames that do not have data present, and is
945   *	also not used for 802.3 format frames. Note that even if the frame
946   *	is on a specific link, address translation might still apply if
947   *	it's intended for an MLD.
948   *
949   * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags.
950   */
951  enum mac80211_tx_control_flags {
952  	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO	= BIT(0),
953  	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE		= BIT(1),
954  	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT		= BIT(2),
955  	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU			= BIT(3),
956  	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT		= BIT(4),
957  	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP	= BIT(5),
958  	IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING	= BIT(6),
959  	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO		= BIT(7),
960  	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER		= BIT(8),
961  	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX	= BIT(9),
962  	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_USE_RATE_MASK	= BIT(10),
963  	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK		= 0xf0000000,
964  };
965  
966  #define IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED	0xf
967  #define IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK_UNSPEC	\
968  	u32_encode_bits(IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, \
969  			IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK)
970  
971  /**
972   * enum mac80211_tx_status_flags - flags to describe transmit status
973   *
974   * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID: ACK signal is valid
975   *
976   * These flags are used in tx_info->status.flags.
977   */
978  enum mac80211_tx_status_flags {
979  	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID = BIT(0),
980  };
981  
982  /*
983   * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are
984   * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack.
985   */
986  #define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK |		      \
987  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT |    \
988  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU |	      \
989  	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED |	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK |		      \
990  	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK |	      \
991  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER |    \
992  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC |		      \
993  	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
994  
995  /**
996   * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the
997   *	Rate Control algorithm.
998   *
999   * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx,
1000   * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate.
1001   *
1002   * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate.
1003   * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required.
1004   *	This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection.
1005   * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble.
1006   * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate.
1007   * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split
1008   *	into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number)
1009   * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in
1010   *	Greenfield mode.
1011   * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz.
1012   * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission
1013   * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission
1014   *	(80+80 isn't supported yet)
1015   * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the
1016   *	adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is
1017   *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS.
1018   * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate.
1019   */
1020  enum mac80211_rate_control_flags {
1021  	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS		= BIT(0),
1022  	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT		= BIT(1),
1023  	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= BIT(2),
1024  
1025  	/* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */
1026  	IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS			= BIT(3),
1027  	IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD		= BIT(4),
1028  	IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(5),
1029  	IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA		= BIT(6),
1030  	IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI		= BIT(7),
1031  	IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS			= BIT(8),
1032  	IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(9),
1033  	IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(10),
1034  };
1035  
1036  
1037  /* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */
1038  #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40
1039  
1040  /* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */
1041  #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24
1042  
1043  /* maximum number of rate stages */
1044  #define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES	4
1045  
1046  /* maximum number of rate table entries */
1047  #define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE	4
1048  
1049  /**
1050   * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status
1051   *
1052   * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with
1053   * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags)
1054   * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate
1055   *
1056   * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used
1057   * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried.
1058   *
1059   * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should
1060   * always report the rate along with the flags it used.
1061   *
1062   * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs
1063   * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate
1064   * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example,
1065   * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the
1066   * information::
1067   *
1068   *    { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 }
1069   *
1070   * then this means that the frame should be transmitted
1071   * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four
1072   * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets
1073   * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status
1074   * information should then contain::
1075   *
1076   *   { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ...
1077   *
1078   * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2
1079   * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement.
1080   */
1081  struct ieee80211_tx_rate {
1082  	s8 idx;
1083  	u16 count:5,
1084  	    flags:11;
1085  } __packed;
1086  
1087  #define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY		31
1088  
ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate,u8 mcs,u8 nss)1089  static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate,
1090  					  u8 mcs, u8 nss)
1091  {
1092  	WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF);
1093  	WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7);
1094  	rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs;
1095  }
1096  
1097  static inline u8
ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate)1098  ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1099  {
1100  	return rate->idx & 0xF;
1101  }
1102  
1103  static inline u8
ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate)1104  ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1105  {
1106  	return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1;
1107  }
1108  
1109  /**
1110   * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information
1111   *
1112   * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses:
1113   *  (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do
1114   *  (2) driver internal use (if applicable)
1115   *  (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened
1116   *
1117   * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above
1118   * @band: the band to transmit on (use e.g. for checking for races),
1119   *	not valid if the interface is an MLD since we won't know which
1120   *	link the frame will be transmitted on
1121   * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC
1122   * @ack_frame_id: internal frame ID for TX status, used internally
1123   * @tx_time_est: TX time estimate in units of 4us, used internally
1124   * @control: union part for control data
1125   * @control.rates: TX rates array to try
1126   * @control.rts_cts_rate_idx: rate for RTS or CTS
1127   * @control.use_rts: use RTS
1128   * @control.use_cts_prot: use RTS/CTS
1129   * @control.short_preamble: use short preamble (CCK only)
1130   * @control.skip_table: skip externally configured rate table
1131   * @control.jiffies: timestamp for expiry on powersave clients
1132   * @control.vif: virtual interface (may be NULL)
1133   * @control.hw_key: key to encrypt with (may be NULL)
1134   * @control.flags: control flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_control_flags
1135   * @control.enqueue_time: enqueue time (for iTXQs)
1136   * @driver_rates: alias to @control.rates to reserve space
1137   * @pad: padding
1138   * @rate_driver_data: driver use area if driver needs @control.rates
1139   * @status: union part for status data
1140   * @status.rates: attempted rates
1141   * @status.ack_signal: ACK signal
1142   * @status.ampdu_ack_len: AMPDU ack length
1143   * @status.ampdu_len: AMPDU length
1144   * @status.antenna: (legacy, kept only for iwlegacy)
1145   * @status.tx_time: airtime consumed for transmission; note this is only
1146   *	used for WMM AC, not for airtime fairness
1147   * @status.flags: status flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_status_flags
1148   * @status.status_driver_data: driver use area
1149   * @ack: union part for pure ACK data
1150   * @ack.cookie: cookie for the ACK
1151   * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers
1152   * @ampdu_ack_len: number of acked aggregated frames.
1153   * 	relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set.
1154   * @ampdu_len: number of aggregated frames.
1155   * 	relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set.
1156   * @ack_signal: signal strength of the ACK frame
1157   */
1158  struct ieee80211_tx_info {
1159  	/* common information */
1160  	u32 flags;
1161  	u32 band:3,
1162  	    ack_frame_id:13,
1163  	    hw_queue:4,
1164  	    tx_time_est:10;
1165  	/* 2 free bits */
1166  
1167  	union {
1168  		struct {
1169  			union {
1170  				/* rate control */
1171  				struct {
1172  					struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[
1173  						IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1174  					s8 rts_cts_rate_idx;
1175  					u8 use_rts:1;
1176  					u8 use_cts_prot:1;
1177  					u8 short_preamble:1;
1178  					u8 skip_table:1;
1179  					/* 2 bytes free */
1180  				};
1181  				/* only needed before rate control */
1182  				unsigned long jiffies;
1183  			};
1184  			/* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */
1185  			struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
1186  			struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key;
1187  			u32 flags;
1188  			codel_time_t enqueue_time;
1189  		} control;
1190  		struct {
1191  			u64 cookie;
1192  		} ack;
1193  		struct {
1194  			struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1195  			s32 ack_signal;
1196  			u8 ampdu_ack_len;
1197  			u8 ampdu_len;
1198  			u8 antenna;
1199  			u8 pad;
1200  			u16 tx_time;
1201  			u8 flags;
1202  			u8 pad2;
1203  			void *status_driver_data[16 / sizeof(void *)];
1204  		} status;
1205  		struct {
1206  			struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[
1207  				IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1208  			u8 pad[4];
1209  
1210  			void *rate_driver_data[
1211  				IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1212  		};
1213  		void *driver_data[
1214  			IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1215  	};
1216  };
1217  
1218  static inline u16
ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info,u16 tx_time_est)1219  ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, u16 tx_time_est)
1220  {
1221  	/* We only have 10 bits in tx_time_est, so store airtime
1222  	 * in increments of 4us and clamp the maximum to 2**12-1
1223  	 */
1224  	info->tx_time_est = min_t(u16, tx_time_est, 4095) >> 2;
1225  	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1226  }
1227  
1228  static inline u16
ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)1229  ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1230  {
1231  	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1232  }
1233  
1234  /***
1235   * struct ieee80211_rate_status - mrr stage for status path
1236   *
1237   * This struct is used in struct ieee80211_tx_status to provide drivers a
1238   * dynamic way to report about used rates and power levels per packet.
1239   *
1240   * @rate_idx The actual used rate.
1241   * @try_count How often the rate was tried.
1242   * @tx_power_idx An idx into the ieee80211_hw->tx_power_levels list of the
1243   * 	corresponding wifi hardware. The idx shall point to the power level
1244   * 	that was used when sending the packet.
1245   */
1246  struct ieee80211_rate_status {
1247  	struct rate_info rate_idx;
1248  	u8 try_count;
1249  	u8 tx_power_idx;
1250  };
1251  
1252  /**
1253   * struct ieee80211_tx_status - extended tx status info for rate control
1254   *
1255   * @sta: Station that the packet was transmitted for
1256   * @info: Basic tx status information
1257   * @skb: Packet skb (can be NULL if not provided by the driver)
1258   * @rates: Mrr stages that were used when sending the packet
1259   * @n_rates: Number of mrr stages (count of instances for @rates)
1260   * @free_list: list where processed skbs are stored to be free'd by the driver
1261   * @ack_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp of the received ack in nanoseconds
1262   *	Only needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action
1263   *	frames. Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1264   */
1265  struct ieee80211_tx_status {
1266  	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
1267  	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info;
1268  	struct sk_buff *skb;
1269  	struct ieee80211_rate_status *rates;
1270  	ktime_t ack_hwtstamp;
1271  	u8 n_rates;
1272  
1273  	struct list_head *free_list;
1274  };
1275  
1276  /**
1277   * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs
1278   *
1279   * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan
1280   * and scheduled scan. These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace
1281   * and the ones generated by mac80211.
1282   *
1283   * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs.
1284   * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs.
1285   * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones)
1286   * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies
1287   */
1288  struct ieee80211_scan_ies {
1289  	const u8 *ies[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1290  	size_t len[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1291  	const u8 *common_ies;
1292  	size_t common_ie_len;
1293  };
1294  
1295  
IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff * skb)1296  static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1297  {
1298  	return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb;
1299  }
1300  
IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff * skb)1301  static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1302  {
1303  	return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb;
1304  }
1305  
1306  /**
1307   * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status
1308   *
1309   * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared.
1310   *
1311   * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report
1312   * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything
1313   * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear
1314   * the count since you need to fill that in anyway).
1315   *
1316   * NOTE: While the rates array is kept intact, this will wipe all of the
1317   *	 driver_data fields in info, so it's up to the driver to restore
1318   *	 any fields it needs after calling this helper.
1319   */
1320  static inline void
ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)1321  ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1322  {
1323  	int i;
1324  
1325  	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1326  		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates));
1327  	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1328  		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates));
1329  	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8);
1330  	/* clear the rate counts */
1331  	for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++)
1332  		info->status.rates[i].count = 0;
1333  	memset_after(&info->status, 0, rates);
1334  }
1335  
1336  
1337  /**
1338   * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags
1339   *
1340   * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status.
1341   * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame.
1342   *	Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED.
1343   * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware.
1344   * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame,
1345   *	verification has been done by the hardware.
1346   * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV and ICV are stripped from this frame.
1347   *	If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection
1348   *	hence the driver or hardware will have to do that.
1349   * @RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED: Currently only valid for CCMP/GCMP frames, this
1350   *	flag indicates that the PN was verified for replay protection.
1351   *	Note that this flag is also currently only supported when a frame
1352   *	is also decrypted (ie. @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED must be set)
1353   * @RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED: The driver should set this flag if it did
1354   *	de-duplication by itself.
1355   * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on
1356   *	the frame.
1357   * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on
1358   *	the frame.
1359   * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1360   *	field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU
1361   *	was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS
1362   *	merging.
1363   * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1364   *	field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU
1365   *	(including FCS) was received.
1366   * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1367   *	field) is valid and contains the time the SYNC preamble was received.
1368   * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present.
1369   *	Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU)
1370   * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference
1371   *	number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for
1372   *	each A-MPDU
1373   * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all
1374   *	subframes of a single A-MPDU
1375   * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU
1376   * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected
1377   *	on this subframe
1378   * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN: The delimiter CRC field is known (the CRC
1379   *	is stored in the @ampdu_delimiter_crc field)
1380   * @RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED: The mic was stripped of this packet. Decryption was
1381   *	done by the hardware
1382   * @RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR: Report frame only to monitor interfaces without
1383   *	processing it in any regular way.
1384   *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1385   *	them for sniffing purposes.
1386   * @RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR: Process and report frame to all interfaces except
1387   *	monitor interfaces.
1388   *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1389   *	them for sniffing purposes.
1390   * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU
1391   *	subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons.
1392   *	All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g.
1393   *	if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while
1394   *	the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to
1395   *	deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU
1396   *	subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be
1397   *	either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be
1398   *	interleaved with other frames.
1399   * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END: This frame contains radiotap TLVs in the
1400   *	skb->data (before the 802.11 header).
1401   *	If used, the SKB's mac_header pointer must be set to point
1402   *	to the 802.11 header after the TLVs, and any padding added after TLV
1403   *	data to align to 4 must be cleared by the driver putting the TLVs
1404   *	in the skb.
1405   * @RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN: Allow the same PN as same packet before.
1406   *	This is used for AMSDU subframes which can have the same PN as
1407   *	the first subframe.
1408   * @RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED: The ICV is stripped from this frame. CRC checking must
1409   *	be done in the hardware.
1410   * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT: Value of the EOF bit in the A-MPDU delimiter for this
1411   *	frame
1412   * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN: The EOF value is known
1413   * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE: HE radiotap data is present
1414   *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he, mac80211 will fill in
1415   *
1416   *	 - DATA3_DATA_MCS
1417   *	 - DATA3_DATA_DCM
1418   *	 - DATA3_CODING
1419   *	 - DATA5_GI
1420   *	 - DATA5_DATA_BW_RU_ALLOC
1421   *	 - DATA6_NSTS
1422   *	 - DATA3_STBC
1423   *
1424   *	from the RX info data, so leave those zeroed when building this data)
1425   * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU: HE MU radiotap data is present
1426   *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he_mu)
1427   * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG: L-SIG radiotap data is present
1428   * @RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU: use the frame only for radiotap reporting, with
1429   *	the "0-length PSDU" field included there.  The value for it is
1430   *	in &struct ieee80211_rx_status.  Note that if this value isn't
1431   *	known the frame shouldn't be reported.
1432   * @RX_FLAG_8023: the frame has an 802.3 header (decap offload performed by
1433   *	hardware or driver)
1434   */
1435  enum mac80211_rx_flags {
1436  	RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR		= BIT(0),
1437  	RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED		= BIT(1),
1438  	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START	= BIT(2),
1439  	RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(3),
1440  	RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED		= BIT(4),
1441  	RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC		= BIT(5),
1442  	RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC 	= BIT(6),
1443  	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START		= BIT(7),
1444  	RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL		= BIT(8),
1445  	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS		= BIT(9),
1446  	RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED		= BIT(10),
1447  	RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED		= BIT(11),
1448  	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN	= BIT(12),
1449  	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST		= BIT(13),
1450  	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR	= BIT(14),
1451  	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN	= BIT(15),
1452  	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END		= BIT(16),
1453  	RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR		= BIT(17),
1454  	RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR		= BIT(18),
1455  	RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE		= BIT(19),
1456  	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END	= BIT(20),
1457  	RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(21),
1458  	RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN		= BIT(22),
1459  	RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED		= BIT(23),
1460  	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT		= BIT(24),
1461  	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN	= BIT(25),
1462  	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE		= BIT(26),
1463  	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU		= BIT(27),
1464  	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG		= BIT(28),
1465  	RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU			= BIT(29),
1466  	RX_FLAG_8023			= BIT(30),
1467  };
1468  
1469  /**
1470   * enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags - MCS & bandwidth flags
1471   *
1472   * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame
1473   * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used
1474   * @RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission,
1475   *	if the driver fills this value it should add
1476   *	%IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT
1477   *	to @hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact.
1478   * @RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used
1479   * @RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3
1480   * @RX_ENC_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed
1481   */
1482  enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags {
1483  	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE		= BIT(0),
1484  	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI		= BIT(2),
1485  	RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF		= BIT(3),
1486  	RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK		= BIT(4) | BIT(5),
1487  	RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC		= BIT(6),
1488  	RX_ENC_FLAG_BF			= BIT(7),
1489  };
1490  
1491  #define RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT		4
1492  
1493  enum mac80211_rx_encoding {
1494  	RX_ENC_LEGACY = 0,
1495  	RX_ENC_HT,
1496  	RX_ENC_VHT,
1497  	RX_ENC_HE,
1498  	RX_ENC_EHT,
1499  };
1500  
1501  /**
1502   * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status
1503   *
1504   * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset
1505   * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received
1506   * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb).
1507   *
1508   * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function
1509   * 	(TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware.
1510   * @boottime_ns: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp the frame was received at, this is
1511   *	needed only for beacons and probe responses that update the scan cache.
1512   * @ack_tx_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp for the ack TX in nanoseconds. Only
1513   *	needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action frames.
1514   *	Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1515   * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use
1516   *	it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation
1517   * @band: the active band when this frame was received
1518   * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz
1519   *	This field must be set for management frames, but isn't strictly needed
1520   *	for data (other) frames - for those it only affects radiotap reporting.
1521   * @freq_offset: @freq has a positive offset of 500Khz.
1522   * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or
1523   *	unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags
1524   *	@IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_*
1525   * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength
1526   *	values were filled.
1527   * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't
1528   *	support dB or unspecified units)
1529   * @antenna: antenna used
1530   * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if
1531   *	HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT)
1532   * @nss: number of streams (VHT, HE and EHT only)
1533   * @flag: %RX_FLAG_\*
1534   * @encoding: &enum mac80211_rx_encoding
1535   * @bw: &enum rate_info_bw
1536   * @enc_flags: uses bits from &enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags
1537   * @he_ru: HE RU, from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc
1538   * @he_gi: HE GI, from &enum nl80211_he_gi
1539   * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1540   * @eht: EHT specific rate information
1541   * @eht.ru: EHT RU, from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc
1542   * @eht.gi: EHT GI, from &enum nl80211_eht_gi
1543   * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211
1544   * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for
1545   *	each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU
1546   * @ampdu_delimiter_crc: A-MPDU delimiter CRC
1547   * @zero_length_psdu_type: radiotap type of the 0-length PSDU
1548   * @link_valid: if the link which is identified by @link_id is valid. This flag
1549   *	is set only when connection is MLO.
1550   * @link_id: id of the link used to receive the packet. This is used along with
1551   *	@link_valid.
1552   */
1553  struct ieee80211_rx_status {
1554  	u64 mactime;
1555  	union {
1556  		u64 boottime_ns;
1557  		ktime_t ack_tx_hwtstamp;
1558  	};
1559  	u32 device_timestamp;
1560  	u32 ampdu_reference;
1561  	u32 flag;
1562  	u16 freq: 13, freq_offset: 1;
1563  	u8 enc_flags;
1564  	u8 encoding:3, bw:4;
1565  	union {
1566  		struct {
1567  			u8 he_ru:3;
1568  			u8 he_gi:2;
1569  			u8 he_dcm:1;
1570  		};
1571  		struct {
1572  			u8 ru:4;
1573  			u8 gi:2;
1574  		} eht;
1575  	};
1576  	u8 rate_idx;
1577  	u8 nss;
1578  	u8 rx_flags;
1579  	u8 band;
1580  	u8 antenna;
1581  	s8 signal;
1582  	u8 chains;
1583  	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1584  	u8 ampdu_delimiter_crc;
1585  	u8 zero_length_psdu_type;
1586  	u8 link_valid:1, link_id:4;
1587  };
1588  
1589  static inline u32
ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status * rx_status)1590  ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status *rx_status)
1591  {
1592  	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(rx_status->freq) +
1593  	       (rx_status->freq_offset ? 500 : 0);
1594  }
1595  
1596  /**
1597   * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags
1598   *
1599   * Flags to define PHY configuration options
1600   *
1601   * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this
1602   *	to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets
1603   *	or not, do not use instead of filter flags!
1604   * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only).
1605   *	This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2,
1606   *	meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to
1607   *	transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames.
1608   *	Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states,
1609   *	driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support"
1610   *	for more.
1611   * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set
1612   *	the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but
1613   *	may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will
1614   *	be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but
1615   *	it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active.
1616   * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main
1617   *	operating channel.
1618   */
1619  enum ieee80211_conf_flags {
1620  	IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR		= (1<<0),
1621  	IEEE80211_CONF_PS		= (1<<1),
1622  	IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE		= (1<<2),
1623  	IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL	= (1<<3),
1624  };
1625  
1626  
1627  /**
1628   * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed
1629   *
1630   * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed
1631   * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed
1632   * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed
1633   * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed
1634   * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed
1635   * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed
1636   * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed
1637   * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed
1638   *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1639   *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1640   */
1641  enum ieee80211_conf_changed {
1642  	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS		= BIT(1),
1643  	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL	= BIT(2),
1644  	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR		= BIT(3),
1645  	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS		= BIT(4),
1646  	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER		= BIT(5),
1647  	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL		= BIT(6),
1648  	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS	= BIT(7),
1649  	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE		= BIT(8),
1650  };
1651  
1652  /**
1653   * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode
1654   *
1655   * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic
1656   * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off
1657   * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static
1658   * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic
1659   * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use
1660   */
1661  enum ieee80211_smps_mode {
1662  	IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC,
1663  	IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF,
1664  	IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC,
1665  	IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
1666  
1667  	/* keep last */
1668  	IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES,
1669  };
1670  
1671  /**
1672   * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device
1673   *
1674   * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware.
1675   *
1676   * @flags: configuration flags defined above
1677   *
1678   * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval
1679   * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use
1680   *	in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon
1681   *	has been received and the DTIM period is known.
1682   * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the
1683   *	powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when
1684   *	the CONF_PS flag is set.
1685   *
1686   * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility
1687   *	value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces
1688   *
1689   * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to
1690   * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled
1691   *
1692   * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame
1693   *	(a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11,
1694   *	but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries
1695   * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short"
1696   *	frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the
1697   *	number of transmissions not the number of retries
1698   *
1699   * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that
1700   *	%IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not
1701   *	configured for an HT channel.
1702   *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1703   *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1704   */
1705  struct ieee80211_conf {
1706  	u32 flags;
1707  	int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout;
1708  
1709  	u16 listen_interval;
1710  	u8 ps_dtim_period;
1711  
1712  	u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count;
1713  
1714  	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1715  	bool radar_enabled;
1716  	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1717  };
1718  
1719  /**
1720   * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data
1721   *
1722   * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch
1723   * operation.
1724   *
1725   * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization
1726   *	Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch
1727   *	announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter
1728   *	the driver passed into mac80211.
1729   * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, this is the
1730   *	rx.device_timestamp parameter the driver passed to mac80211.
1731   * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the
1732   *	scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP.
1733   * @chandef: the new channel to switch to
1734   * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event
1735   * @delay: maximum delay between the time the AP transmitted the last beacon in
1736    *	current channel and the expected time of the first beacon in the new
1737    *	channel, expressed in TU.
1738   */
1739  struct ieee80211_channel_switch {
1740  	u64 timestamp;
1741  	u32 device_timestamp;
1742  	bool block_tx;
1743  	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1744  	u8 count;
1745  	u32 delay;
1746  };
1747  
1748  /**
1749   * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags
1750   *
1751   * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering
1752   *	on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups
1753   * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality
1754   *	monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor
1755   *	connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and
1756   *	provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached.
1757   * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: The device can do U-APSD for this
1758   *	interface. This flag should be set during interface addition,
1759   *	but may be set/cleared as late as authentication to an AP. It is
1760   *	only valid for managed/station mode interfaces.
1761   * @IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE: request to handle NOA attributes
1762   *	and send P2P_PS notification to the driver if NOA changed, even
1763   *	this is not pure P2P vif.
1764   * @IEEE80211_VIF_DISABLE_SMPS_OVERRIDE: disable user configuration of
1765   *	SMPS mode via debugfs.
1766   */
1767  enum ieee80211_vif_flags {
1768  	IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER		= BIT(0),
1769  	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI		= BIT(1),
1770  	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD		= BIT(2),
1771  	IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE		= BIT(3),
1772  	IEEE80211_VIF_DISABLE_SMPS_OVERRIDE	= BIT(4),
1773  };
1774  
1775  
1776  /**
1777   * enum ieee80211_offload_flags - virtual interface offload flags
1778   *
1779   * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED: tx encapsulation offload is enabled
1780   *	The driver supports sending frames passed as 802.3 frames by mac80211.
1781   *	It must also support sending 802.11 packets for the same interface.
1782   * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR: support 4-address mode encapsulation offload
1783   * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED: rx encapsulation offload is enabled
1784   *	The driver supports passing received 802.11 frames as 802.3 frames to
1785   *	mac80211.
1786   */
1787  
1788  enum ieee80211_offload_flags {
1789  	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED		= BIT(0),
1790  	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR		= BIT(1),
1791  	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED		= BIT(2),
1792  };
1793  
1794  /**
1795   * struct ieee80211_vif_cfg - interface configuration
1796   * @assoc: association status
1797   * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS or not
1798   * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created
1799   * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by
1800   *	offchannel/dynamic_ps operations.
1801   * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true
1802   * @eml_cap: EML capabilities as described in P802.11be_D2.2 Figure 9-1002k.
1803   * @eml_med_sync_delay: Medium Synchronization delay as described in
1804   *	P802.11be_D2.2 Figure 9-1002j.
1805   * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The
1806   *	may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here.
1807   *	The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here
1808   *	to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass.
1809   * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this
1810   *	may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list
1811   *	array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case.
1812   * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode.
1813   * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid.
1814   * @s1g: BSS is S1G BSS (affects Association Request format).
1815   * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the
1816   *	hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what
1817   *	your driver/device needs to do.
1818   * @ap_addr: AP MLD address, or BSSID for non-MLO connections
1819   *	(station mode only)
1820   */
1821  struct ieee80211_vif_cfg {
1822  	/* association related data */
1823  	bool assoc, ibss_joined;
1824  	bool ibss_creator;
1825  	bool ps;
1826  	u16 aid;
1827  	u16 eml_cap;
1828  	u16 eml_med_sync_delay;
1829  
1830  	__be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN];
1831  	int arp_addr_cnt;
1832  	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
1833  	size_t ssid_len;
1834  	bool s1g;
1835  	bool idle;
1836  	u8 ap_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1837  };
1838  
1839  /**
1840   * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data
1841   *
1842   * Data in this structure is continually present for driver
1843   * use during the life of a virtual interface.
1844   *
1845   * @type: type of this virtual interface
1846   * @cfg: vif configuration, see &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg
1847   * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own
1848   *	or the BSS we're associated to
1849   * @link_conf: in case of MLD, the per-link BSS configuration,
1850   *	indexed by link ID
1851   * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1852   * @active_links: The bitmap of active links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1853   *	The driver shouldn't change this directly, but use the
1854   *	API calls meant for that purpose.
1855   * @dormant_links: bitmap of valid but disabled links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1856   *	Must be a subset of valid_links.
1857   * @addr: address of this interface
1858   * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p
1859   *	interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively
1860   * @netdev_features: tx netdev features supported by the hardware for this
1861   *	vif. mac80211 initializes this to hw->netdev_features, and the driver
1862   *	can mask out specific tx features. mac80211 will handle software fixup
1863   *	for masked offloads (GSO, CSUM)
1864   * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface,
1865   *	these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added
1866   *	or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed
1867   *	at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field
1868   * @offload_flags: hardware offload capabilities/flags for this interface.
1869   *	These are initialized by mac80211 before calling .add_interface,
1870   *	.change_interface or .update_vif_offload and updated by the driver
1871   *	within these ops, based on supported features or runtime change
1872   *	restrictions.
1873   * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC
1874   * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only
1875   * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per
1876   *	interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual
1877   *	monitor interface (if that is requested.)
1878   * @probe_req_reg: probe requests should be reported to mac80211 for this
1879   *	interface.
1880   * @rx_mcast_action_reg: multicast Action frames should be reported to mac80211
1881   *	for this interface.
1882   * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
1883   *	sizeof(void \*).
1884   * @txq: the multicast data TX queue
1885   * @offload_flags: 802.3 -> 802.11 enapsulation offload flags, see
1886   *	&enum ieee80211_offload_flags.
1887   * @mbssid_tx_vif: Pointer to the transmitting interface if MBSSID is enabled.
1888   */
1889  struct ieee80211_vif {
1890  	enum nl80211_iftype type;
1891  	struct ieee80211_vif_cfg cfg;
1892  	struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf;
1893  	struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *link_conf[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
1894  	u16 valid_links, active_links, dormant_links;
1895  	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1896  	bool p2p;
1897  
1898  	u8 cab_queue;
1899  	u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS];
1900  
1901  	struct ieee80211_txq *txq;
1902  
1903  	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
1904  	u32 driver_flags;
1905  	u32 offload_flags;
1906  
1907  #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
1908  	struct dentry *debugfs_dir;
1909  #endif
1910  
1911  	bool probe_req_reg;
1912  	bool rx_mcast_action_reg;
1913  
1914  	struct ieee80211_vif *mbssid_tx_vif;
1915  
1916  	/* must be last */
1917  	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
1918  };
1919  
1920  /**
1921   * ieee80211_vif_usable_links - Return the usable links for the vif
1922   * @vif: the vif for which the usable links are requested
1923   * Return: the usable link bitmap
1924   */
ieee80211_vif_usable_links(const struct ieee80211_vif * vif)1925  static inline u16 ieee80211_vif_usable_links(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1926  {
1927  	return vif->valid_links & ~vif->dormant_links;
1928  }
1929  
1930  /**
1931   * ieee80211_vif_is_mld - Returns true iff the vif is an MLD one
1932   * @vif: the vif
1933   * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD, %false otherwise.
1934   */
ieee80211_vif_is_mld(const struct ieee80211_vif * vif)1935  static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mld(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1936  {
1937  	/* valid_links != 0 indicates this vif is an MLD */
1938  	return vif->valid_links != 0;
1939  }
1940  
1941  #define for_each_vif_active_link(vif, link, link_id)				\
1942  	for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((vif)->link_conf); link_id++)	\
1943  		if ((!(vif)->active_links ||					\
1944  		     (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) &&			\
1945  		    (link = rcu_dereference((vif)->link_conf[link_id])))
1946  
ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)1947  static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1948  {
1949  #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH
1950  	return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT;
1951  #endif
1952  	return false;
1953  }
1954  
1955  /**
1956   * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev
1957   * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for
1958   *
1959   * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
1960   * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev.
1961   *
1962   * Note that this function may return %NULL if the given wdev isn't
1963   * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor
1964   * or AP_VLAN interfaces.)
1965   */
1966  struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
1967  
1968  /**
1969   * ieee80211_vif_to_wdev - return a wdev struct from a vif
1970   * @vif: the vif to get the wdev for
1971   *
1972   * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
1973   * (like the vendor commands) that needs to get the wdev for a vif.
1974   * This can also be useful to get the netdev associated to a vif.
1975   */
1976  struct wireless_dev *ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
1977  
1978  /**
1979   * lockdep_vif_mutex_held - for lockdep checks on link poiners
1980   * @vif: the interface to check
1981   */
lockdep_vif_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)1982  static inline bool lockdep_vif_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1983  {
1984  	return lockdep_is_held(&ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(vif)->mtx);
1985  }
1986  
1987  #define link_conf_dereference_protected(vif, link_id)		\
1988  	rcu_dereference_protected((vif)->link_conf[link_id],	\
1989  				  lockdep_vif_mutex_held(vif))
1990  
1991  #define link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id)		\
1992  	rcu_dereference_check((vif)->link_conf[link_id],	\
1993  			      lockdep_vif_mutex_held(vif))
1994  
1995  /**
1996   * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags
1997   *
1998   * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver
1999   * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf.
2000   *
2001   * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the
2002   *	driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this
2003   *	particular key. Setting this flag does not necessarily mean that SKBs
2004   *	will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or MIC.
2005   * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by
2006   *	the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC
2007   *	generation in software.
2008   * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates
2009   *	that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key.
2010   * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a
2011   *	CCMP/GCMP key if it requires CCMP/GCMP encryption of management frames
2012   *	(MFP) to be done in software.
2013   * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver
2014   *	if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV
2015   *	itself should not be generated. Do not set together with
2016   *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. Setting this flag does
2017   *	not necessarily mean that SKBs will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or
2018   *	MIC.
2019   * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received
2020   *	management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware
2021   *	crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames
2022   *	properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and
2023   *	fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with
2024   *	RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the
2025   *	%IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW.
2026   * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the
2027   *	driver for a CCMP/GCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation
2028   *	only for management frames (MFP).
2029   * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM: This flag should be set by the
2030   *	driver for a key to indicate that sufficient tailroom must always
2031   *	be reserved for ICV or MIC, even when HW encryption is enabled.
2032   * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver for
2033   *	a TKIP key if it only requires MIC space. Do not set together with
2034   *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC on the same key.
2035   * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX: Key needs explicit Tx activation.
2036   * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE: This flag should be set by the driver
2037   *	for a AES_CMAC key to indicate that it requires sequence number
2038   *	generation only
2039   */
2040  enum ieee80211_key_flags {
2041  	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT	= BIT(0),
2042  	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV		= BIT(1),
2043  	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC	= BIT(2),
2044  	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE		= BIT(3),
2045  	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX		= BIT(4),
2046  	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE		= BIT(5),
2047  	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT		= BIT(6),
2048  	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM	= BIT(7),
2049  	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE	= BIT(8),
2050  	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX		= BIT(9),
2051  	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE	= BIT(10),
2052  };
2053  
2054  /**
2055   * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information
2056   *
2057   * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by
2058   * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops.
2059   *
2060   * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver
2061   *	wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be
2062   *	encrypted in hardware.
2063   * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector.
2064   * @tx_pn: PN used for TX keys, may be used by the driver as well if it
2065   *	needs to do software PN assignment by itself (e.g. due to TSO)
2066   * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags.
2067   * @keyidx: the key index (0-3)
2068   * @keylen: key material length
2069   * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte)
2070   * 	data block:
2071   * 	- Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits)
2072   * 	- Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits)
2073   * 	- Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits)
2074   * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type
2075   * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type
2076   * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, or -1 for non-MLO or pairwise keys
2077   */
2078  struct ieee80211_key_conf {
2079  	atomic64_t tx_pn;
2080  	u32 cipher;
2081  	u8 icv_len;
2082  	u8 iv_len;
2083  	u8 hw_key_idx;
2084  	s8 keyidx;
2085  	u16 flags;
2086  	s8 link_id;
2087  	u8 keylen;
2088  	u8 key[];
2089  };
2090  
2091  #define IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN	16
2092  
2093  #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV16(pn) ((u16)(pn & 0xffff))
2094  #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV32(pn) ((u32)((pn >> 16) & 0xffffffff))
2095  
2096  /**
2097   * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter
2098   *
2099   * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order
2100   * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2101   *	reverse order than in packet)
2102   * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2103   *	reverse order than in packet)
2104   * @aes_gmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2105   *	reverse order than in packet)
2106   * @gcmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2107   *	reverse order than in packet)
2108   * @hw: data for HW-only (e.g. cipher scheme) keys
2109   */
2110  struct ieee80211_key_seq {
2111  	union {
2112  		struct {
2113  			u32 iv32;
2114  			u16 iv16;
2115  		} tkip;
2116  		struct {
2117  			u8 pn[6];
2118  		} ccmp;
2119  		struct {
2120  			u8 pn[6];
2121  		} aes_cmac;
2122  		struct {
2123  			u8 pn[6];
2124  		} aes_gmac;
2125  		struct {
2126  			u8 pn[6];
2127  		} gcmp;
2128  		struct {
2129  			u8 seq[IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN];
2130  			u8 seq_len;
2131  		} hw;
2132  	};
2133  };
2134  
2135  /**
2136   * enum set_key_cmd - key command
2137   *
2138   * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2139   * indicates whether a key is being removed or added.
2140   *
2141   * @SET_KEY: a key is set
2142   * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled
2143   */
2144  enum set_key_cmd {
2145  	SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY,
2146  };
2147  
2148  /**
2149   * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state
2150   *
2151   * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all,
2152   *	this is a special state for add/remove transitions
2153   * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state
2154   * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated
2155   * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated
2156   * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
2157   */
2158  enum ieee80211_sta_state {
2159  	/* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */
2160  	IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST,
2161  	IEEE80211_STA_NONE,
2162  	IEEE80211_STA_AUTH,
2163  	IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC,
2164  	IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED,
2165  };
2166  
2167  /**
2168   * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth
2169   * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz
2170   * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz
2171   * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz
2172   * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz
2173   *	(including 80+80 MHz)
2174   * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320: station can receive up to 320 MHz
2175   *
2176   * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized
2177   *	correctly, the values must be sorted.
2178   */
2179  enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth {
2180  	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0,
2181  	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40,
2182  	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80,
2183  	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160,
2184  	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320,
2185  };
2186  
2187  /**
2188   * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table
2189   *
2190   * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update
2191   * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default.
2192   *	Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control.
2193   */
2194  struct ieee80211_sta_rates {
2195  	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2196  	struct {
2197  		s8 idx;
2198  		u8 count;
2199  		u8 count_cts;
2200  		u8 count_rts;
2201  		u16 flags;
2202  	} rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE];
2203  };
2204  
2205  /**
2206   * struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
2207   *
2208   * Used to configure txpower for station.
2209   *
2210   * @power: indicates the tx power, in dBm, to be used when sending data frames
2211   *	to the STA.
2212   * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
2213   *	will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
2214   *	%type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
2215   *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
2216   *	per peer TPC.
2217   */
2218  struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr {
2219  	s16 power;
2220  	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
2221  };
2222  
2223  /**
2224   * struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates - info that is aggregated from active links
2225   *
2226   * Used for any per-link data that needs to be aggregated and updated in the
2227   * main &struct ieee80211_sta when updated or the active links change.
2228   *
2229   * @max_amsdu_len: indicates the maximal length of an A-MSDU in bytes.
2230   *	This field is always valid for packets with a VHT preamble.
2231   *	For packets with a HT preamble, additional limits apply:
2232   *
2233   *	* If the skb is transmitted as part of a BA agreement, the
2234   *	  A-MSDU maximal size is min(max_amsdu_len, 4065) bytes.
2235   *	* If the skb is not part of a BA agreement, the A-MSDU maximal
2236   *	  size is min(max_amsdu_len, 7935) bytes.
2237   *
2238   * Both additional HT limits must be enforced by the low level
2239   * driver. This is defined by the spec (IEEE 802.11-2012 section
2240   * 8.3.2.2 NOTE 2).
2241   * @max_rc_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes recommended by rate control.
2242   * @max_tid_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes for this TID
2243   */
2244  struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates {
2245  	u16 max_amsdu_len;
2246  
2247  	u16 max_rc_amsdu_len;
2248  	u16 max_tid_amsdu_len[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS];
2249  };
2250  
2251  /**
2252   * struct ieee80211_link_sta - station Link specific info
2253   * All link specific info for a STA link for a non MLD STA(single)
2254   * or a MLD STA(multiple entries) are stored here.
2255   *
2256   * @sta: reference to owning STA
2257   * @addr: MAC address of the Link STA. For non-MLO STA this is same as the addr
2258   *	in ieee80211_sta. For MLO Link STA this addr can be same or different
2259   *	from addr in ieee80211_sta (representing MLD STA addr)
2260   * @link_id: the link ID for this link STA (0 for deflink)
2261   * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic)
2262   * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates
2263   * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2264   * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2265   * @he_cap: HE capabilities of this STA
2266   * @he_6ghz_capa: on 6 GHz, holds the HE 6 GHz band capabilities
2267   * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities of this STA
2268   * @agg: per-link data for multi-link aggregation
2269   * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with
2270   * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the
2271   *	station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode
2272   *	notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after
2273   *	the station moves to associated state.
2274   * @txpwr: the station tx power configuration
2275   *
2276   */
2277  struct ieee80211_link_sta {
2278  	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2279  
2280  	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2281  	u8 link_id;
2282  	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
2283  
2284  	u32 supp_rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2285  	struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
2286  	struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
2287  	struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
2288  	struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
2289  	struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap;
2290  
2291  	struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates agg;
2292  
2293  	u8 rx_nss;
2294  	enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth;
2295  	struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr txpwr;
2296  };
2297  
2298  /**
2299   * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry
2300   *
2301   * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly
2302   * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in
2303   * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must
2304   * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly,
2305   * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a
2306   * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it.
2307   * This also represents the MLD STA in case of MLO association
2308   * and holds pointers to various link STA's
2309   *
2310   * @addr: MAC address
2311   * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP
2312   * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximal amount of frames in a single AMPDU
2313   *	that this station is allowed to transmit to us.
2314   *	Can be modified by driver.
2315   * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports QoS/WME (if local devices does,
2316   *	otherwise always false)
2317   * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2318   *	sizeof(void \*), size is determined in hw information.
2319   * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid
2320   *	if wme is supported. The bits order is like in
2321   *	IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_*.
2322   * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported.
2323   * @rates: rate control selection table
2324   * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer
2325   * @tdls_initiator: indicates the STA is an initiator of the TDLS link. Only
2326   *	valid if the STA is a TDLS peer in the first place.
2327   * @mfp: indicates whether the STA uses management frame protection or not.
2328   * @mlo: indicates whether the STA is MLO station.
2329   * @max_amsdu_subframes: indicates the maximal number of MSDUs in a single
2330   *	A-MSDU. Taken from the Extended Capabilities element. 0 means
2331   *	unlimited.
2332   * @cur: currently valid data as aggregated from the active links
2333   *	For non MLO STA it will point to the deflink data. For MLO STA
2334   *	ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates() must be called to update it.
2335   * @support_p2p_ps: indicates whether the STA supports P2P PS mechanism or not.
2336   * @txq: per-TID data TX queues; note that the last entry (%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS)
2337   *	is used for non-data frames
2338   * @deflink: This holds the default link STA information, for non MLO STA all link
2339   *	specific STA information is accessed through @deflink or through
2340   *	link[0] which points to address of @deflink. For MLO Link STA
2341   *	the first added link STA will point to deflink.
2342   * @link: reference to Link Sta entries. For Non MLO STA, except 1st link,
2343   *	i.e link[0] all links would be assigned to NULL by default and
2344   *	would access link information via @deflink or link[0]. For MLO
2345   *	STA, first link STA being added will point its link pointer to
2346   *	@deflink address and remaining would be allocated and the address
2347   *	would be assigned to link[link_id] where link_id is the id assigned
2348   *	by the AP.
2349   * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO
2350   */
2351  struct ieee80211_sta {
2352  	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2353  	u16 aid;
2354  	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2355  	bool wme;
2356  	u8 uapsd_queues;
2357  	u8 max_sp;
2358  	struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates;
2359  	bool tdls;
2360  	bool tdls_initiator;
2361  	bool mfp;
2362  	bool mlo;
2363  	u8 max_amsdu_subframes;
2364  
2365  	struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates *cur;
2366  
2367  	bool support_p2p_ps;
2368  
2369  	struct ieee80211_txq *txq[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS + 1];
2370  
2371  	u16 valid_links;
2372  	struct ieee80211_link_sta deflink;
2373  	struct ieee80211_link_sta __rcu *link[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2374  
2375  	/* must be last */
2376  	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2377  };
2378  
2379  #ifdef CONFIG_LOCKDEP
2380  bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
2381  #else
lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta * pubsta)2382  static inline bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta)
2383  {
2384  	return true;
2385  }
2386  #endif
2387  
2388  #define link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id)		\
2389  	rcu_dereference_protected((sta)->link[link_id],		\
2390  				  lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2391  
2392  #define link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id)		\
2393  	rcu_dereference_check((sta)->link[link_id],		\
2394  			      lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2395  
2396  #define for_each_sta_active_link(vif, sta, link_sta, link_id)			\
2397  	for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((sta)->link); link_id++)		\
2398  		if ((!(vif)->active_links ||					\
2399  		     (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) &&			\
2400  		    ((link_sta) = link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id)))
2401  
2402  /**
2403   * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command
2404   *
2405   * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2406   * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition.
2407   *
2408   * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping
2409   * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up
2410   */
2411  enum sta_notify_cmd {
2412  	STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE,
2413  };
2414  
2415  /**
2416   * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data
2417   *
2418   * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and
2419   * 	it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU.
2420   */
2421  struct ieee80211_tx_control {
2422  	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2423  };
2424  
2425  /**
2426   * struct ieee80211_txq - Software intermediate tx queue
2427   *
2428   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2429   * @sta: station table entry, %NULL for per-vif queue
2430   * @tid: the TID for this queue (unused for per-vif queue),
2431   *	%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS for non-data (if enabled)
2432   * @ac: the AC for this queue
2433   * @drv_priv: driver private area, sized by hw->txq_data_size
2434   *
2435   * The driver can obtain packets from this queue by calling
2436   * ieee80211_tx_dequeue().
2437   */
2438  struct ieee80211_txq {
2439  	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
2440  	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2441  	u8 tid;
2442  	u8 ac;
2443  
2444  	/* must be last */
2445  	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2446  };
2447  
2448  /**
2449   * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags
2450   *
2451   * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to
2452   * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning
2453   * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting
2454   * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule,
2455   * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully.
2456   *
2457   * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL:
2458   *	The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be
2459   *	controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm
2460   *	should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace
2461   *	will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control
2462   *	algorithm.
2463   *	Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of
2464   *	callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have
2465   *	the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config
2466   *	@use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot
2467   *	timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for
2468   *	CCK frames.
2469   *
2470   * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS:
2471   *	Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include
2472   *	the FCS at the end.
2473   *
2474   * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING:
2475   *	Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames
2476   *	for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others
2477   *	rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used
2478   *	to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and
2479   *	multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that
2480   *	the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc().
2481   *
2482   * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC:
2483   *	Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We
2484   *	expect values between 0 and @max_signal.
2485   *	If possible please provide dB or dBm instead.
2486   *
2487   * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM:
2488   *	Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from
2489   *	one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized
2490   *	between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set.
2491   *
2492   * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT:
2493   * 	Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h
2494   * 	Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC
2495   *
2496   * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION:
2497   *	Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation.
2498   *
2499   * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS:
2500   *	Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep).
2501   *
2502   * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK:
2503   *	Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies
2504   *	stack support for dynamic PS.
2505   *
2506   * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS:
2507   *	Hardware has support for dynamic PS.
2508   *
2509   * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE:
2510   *	Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w).
2511   *
2512   * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS:
2513   *	Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to
2514   *	the stack.
2515   *
2516   * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR:
2517   *	The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including
2518   *	periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss.
2519   *
2520   * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC:
2521   *	This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e.
2522   *	dtim_period).
2523   *
2524   * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports
2525   *	per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If
2526   *	the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not
2527   *	to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still
2528   *	possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag
2529   *	only in that case.
2530   *
2531   * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device
2532   *	autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When
2533   *	this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected
2534   *	stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames.
2535   *	Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure
2536   *	the PS mode of connected stations.
2537   *
2538   * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session
2539   *	setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in
2540   *	software.
2541   *
2542   * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of
2543   *	a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only
2544   *	active interfaces.
2545   *
2546   * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF: The driver would like for no wlanX to
2547   *	be created.  It is expected user-space will create vifs as
2548   *	desired (and thus have them named as desired).
2549   *
2550   * @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL: The driver wants to control which of the
2551   *	crypto algorithms can be done in software - so don't automatically
2552   *	try to fall back to it if hardware crypto fails, but do so only if
2553   *	the driver returns 1. This also forces the driver to advertise its
2554   *	supported cipher suites.
2555   *
2556   * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT: The driver/hardware supports fast-xmit,
2557   *	this currently requires only the ability to calculate the duration
2558   *	for frames.
2559   *
2560   * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface
2561   *	queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC)
2562   *	for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue
2563   *	control for more details.
2564   *
2565   * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate
2566   *	selection table provided by the rate control algorithm.
2567   *
2568   * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any
2569   *	P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface
2570   *	is supported.
2571   *
2572   * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames
2573   *	only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon.
2574   *
2575   * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates
2576   *	and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not
2577   *	using aggregation for such frames.)
2578   *
2579   * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA)
2580   *	for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support
2581   *	is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the
2582   *	CSA frame.
2583   *
2584   * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS: The driver will never modify the payload
2585   *	or tailroom of TX skbs without copying them first.
2586   *
2587   * @IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands
2588   *	in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band.
2589   *
2590   * @IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW: The device/driver supports wider bandwidth
2591   *	than then BSS bandwidth for a TDLS link on the base channel.
2592   *
2593   * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU: The driver supports receiving A-MSDUs
2594   *	within A-MPDU.
2595   *
2596   * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS: The device/driver provides TX status
2597   *	for sent beacons.
2598   *
2599   * @IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR: Hardware (or driver) requires that each
2600   *	station has a unique address, i.e. each station entry can be identified
2601   *	by just its MAC address; this prevents, for example, the same station
2602   *	from connecting to two virtual AP interfaces at the same time.
2603   *
2604   * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER: Hardware (or driver) manages the
2605   *	reordering buffer internally, guaranteeing mac80211 receives frames in
2606   *	order and does not need to manage its own reorder buffer or BA session
2607   *	timeout.
2608   *
2609   * @IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS: The device uses RSS and thus requires parallel RX,
2610   *	which implies using per-CPU station statistics.
2611   *
2612   * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU: Hardware (or driver) supports software aggregated
2613   *	A-MSDU frames. Requires software tx queueing and fast-xmit support.
2614   *	When not using minstrel/minstrel_ht rate control, the driver must
2615   *	limit the maximum A-MSDU size based on the current tx rate by setting
2616   *	max_rc_amsdu_len in struct ieee80211_sta.
2617   *
2618   * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST: Hardware (or driver) supports sending frag_list
2619   *	skbs, needed for zero-copy software A-MSDU.
2620   *
2621   * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK: The driver (or firmware) reports low ack event
2622   *	by ieee80211_report_low_ack() based on its own algorithm. For such
2623   *	drivers, mac80211 packet loss mechanism will not be triggered and driver
2624   *	is completely depending on firmware event for station kickout.
2625   *
2626   * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG: Hardware does fragmentation by itself.
2627   *	The stack will not do fragmentation.
2628   *	The callback for @set_frag_threshold should be set as well.
2629   *
2630   * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA: Hardware supports buffer STA on
2631   *	TDLS links.
2632   *
2633   * @IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP: The driver requires the
2634   *	mgd_prepare_tx() callback to be called before transmission of a
2635   *	deauthentication frame in case the association was completed but no
2636   *	beacon was heard. This is required in multi-channel scenarios, where the
2637   *	virtual interface might not be given air time for the transmission of
2638   *	the frame, as it is not synced with the AP/P2P GO yet, and thus the
2639   *	deauthentication frame might not be transmitted.
2640   *
2641   * @IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP: The driver (or firmware) doesn't
2642   *	support QoS NDP for AP probing - that's most likely a driver bug.
2643   *
2644   * @IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ: use the TXQ for bufferable MMPDUs, this of
2645   *	course requires the driver to use TXQs to start with.
2646   *
2647   * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: (Hardware) rate control supports VHT
2648   *	extended NSS BW (dot11VHTExtendedNSSBWCapable). This flag will be set if
2649   *	the selected rate control algorithm sets %RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW
2650   *	but if the rate control is built-in then it must be set by the driver.
2651   *	See also the documentation for that flag.
2652   *
2653   * @IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ: use the extra non-TID per-station TXQ for all
2654   *	MMPDUs on station interfaces. This of course requires the driver to use
2655   *	TXQs to start with.
2656   *
2657   * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN: Driver does not report accurate A-MPDU
2658   *	length in tx status information
2659   *
2660   * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2661   *
2662   * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2663   *	only for HE APs. Applies if @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID is set.
2664   *
2665   * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT: The card and driver is only
2666   *	aggregating MPDUs with the same keyid, allowing mac80211 to keep Tx
2667   *	A-MPDU sessions active while rekeying with Extended Key ID.
2668   *
2669   * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports tx encapsulation
2670   *	offload
2671   *
2672   * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports rx decapsulation
2673   *	offload
2674   *
2675   * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP: Hardware supports concurrent rx
2676   *	decapsulation offload and passing raw 802.11 frames for monitor iface.
2677   *	If this is supported, the driver must pass both 802.3 frames for real
2678   *	usage and 802.11 frames with %RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR set for monitor to
2679   *	the stack.
2680   *
2681   * @IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION: HW/driver has support for BSS color
2682   *	collision detection and doesn't need it in software.
2683   *
2684   * @IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX: Hardware/driver handles transmitting
2685   *	multicast frames on all links, mac80211 should not do that.
2686   *
2687   * @NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS: number of hardware flags, used for sizing arrays
2688   */
2689  enum ieee80211_hw_flags {
2690  	IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL,
2691  	IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS,
2692  	IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING,
2693  	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
2694  	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM,
2695  	IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC,
2696  	IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT,
2697  	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION,
2698  	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS,
2699  	IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK,
2700  	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS,
2701  	IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE,
2702  	IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF,
2703  	IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF,
2704  	IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL,
2705  	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT,
2706  	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS,
2707  	IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR,
2708  	IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL,
2709  	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK,
2710  	IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS,
2711  	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW,
2712  	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE,
2713  	IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF,
2714  	IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY,
2715  	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES,
2716  	IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA,
2717  	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS,
2718  	IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS,
2719  	IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW,
2720  	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU,
2721  	IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS,
2722  	IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR,
2723  	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER,
2724  	IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS,
2725  	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU,
2726  	IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST,
2727  	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK,
2728  	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG,
2729  	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA,
2730  	IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP,
2731  	IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP,
2732  	IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ,
2733  	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW,
2734  	IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ,
2735  	IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN,
2736  	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID,
2737  	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID,
2738  	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT,
2739  	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD,
2740  	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD,
2741  	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP,
2742  	IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION,
2743  	IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX,
2744  
2745  	/* keep last, obviously */
2746  	NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS
2747  };
2748  
2749  /**
2750   * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state
2751   *
2752   * This structure contains the configuration and hardware
2753   * information for an 802.11 PHY.
2754   *
2755   * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this
2756   *	802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev
2757   *	members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV()
2758   *	and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported
2759   *	bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here.
2760   *
2761   * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use.
2762   *
2763   * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use
2764   *	along with this structure.
2765   *
2766   * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags.
2767   *
2768   * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb
2769   *	for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.)
2770   *
2771   * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb.
2772   *	Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs.
2773   *
2774   * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used
2775   *	only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB
2776   *
2777   * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval
2778   *	that HW supports
2779   *
2780   * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for
2781   *	data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these
2782   *	queues need to have configurable access parameters.
2783   *
2784   * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware.
2785   *	If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be
2786   *	set before calling ieee80211_register_hw().
2787   *
2788   * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2789   *	within &struct ieee80211_vif.
2790   * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2791   *	within &struct ieee80211_sta.
2792   * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2793   *	within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf.
2794   * @txq_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2795   *	within @struct ieee80211_txq.
2796   *
2797   * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw
2798   *	can handle.
2799   * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages
2800   *	the hw can report back.
2801   * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage
2802   *
2803   * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of
2804   *	sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver
2805   *	aggregation.
2806   *	This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the
2807   *	number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering
2808   *	it shouldn't be set.
2809   *
2810   * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an
2811   *	aggregate an HT/HE device will transmit. In HT AddBA we'll
2812   *	advertise a constant value of 64 as some older APs crash if
2813   *	the window size is smaller (an example is LinkSys WRT120N
2814   *	with FW v1.0.07 build 002 Jun 18 2012).
2815   *	For AddBA to HE capable peers this value will be used.
2816   *
2817   * @max_tx_fragments: maximum number of tx buffers per (A)-MSDU, sum
2818   *	of 1 + skb_shinfo(skb)->nr_frags for each skb in the frag_list.
2819   *
2820   * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX
2821   *	(if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set)
2822   *
2823   * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW
2824   *	reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't
2825   *	include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_\* values, only
2826   *	adding _BW is supported today.
2827   *
2828   * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports,
2829   *	the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH.
2830   *	Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_\* values.
2831   *
2832   * @radiotap_he: HE radiotap validity flags
2833   *
2834   * @radiotap_timestamp: Information for the radiotap timestamp field; if the
2835   *	@units_pos member is set to a non-negative value then the timestamp
2836   *	field will be added and populated from the &struct ieee80211_rx_status
2837   *	device_timestamp.
2838   * @radiotap_timestamp.units_pos: Must be set to a combination of a
2839   *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_UNIT_* and a
2840   *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_SPOS_* value.
2841   * @radiotap_timestamp.accuracy: If non-negative, fills the accuracy in the
2842   *	radiotap field and the accuracy known flag will be set.
2843   *
2844   * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created
2845   *	from this HW. Note that not all features are usable with mac80211,
2846   *	other features will be rejected during HW registration.
2847   *
2848   * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate
2849   *	for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery-
2850   *	enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap.
2851   *	Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means
2852   *	that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means
2853   *	neither enabled.
2854   *
2855   * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may
2856   *	deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA.
2857   *	Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values.
2858   *
2859   * @max_nan_de_entries: maximum number of NAN DE functions supported by the
2860   *	device.
2861   *
2862   * @tx_sk_pacing_shift: Pacing shift to set on TCP sockets when frames from
2863   *	them are encountered. The default should typically not be changed,
2864   *	unless the driver has good reasons for needing more buffers.
2865   *
2866   * @weight_multiplier: Driver specific airtime weight multiplier used while
2867   *	refilling deficit of each TXQ.
2868   *
2869   * @max_mtu: the max mtu could be set.
2870   *
2871   * @tx_power_levels: a list of power levels supported by the wifi hardware.
2872   * 	The power levels can be specified either as integer or fractions.
2873   * 	The power level at idx 0 shall be the maximum positive power level.
2874   *
2875   * @max_txpwr_levels_idx: the maximum valid idx of 'tx_power_levels' list.
2876   */
2877  struct ieee80211_hw {
2878  	struct ieee80211_conf conf;
2879  	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2880  	const char *rate_control_algorithm;
2881  	void *priv;
2882  	unsigned long flags[BITS_TO_LONGS(NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS)];
2883  	unsigned int extra_tx_headroom;
2884  	unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom;
2885  	int vif_data_size;
2886  	int sta_data_size;
2887  	int chanctx_data_size;
2888  	int txq_data_size;
2889  	u16 queues;
2890  	u16 max_listen_interval;
2891  	s8 max_signal;
2892  	u8 max_rates;
2893  	u8 max_report_rates;
2894  	u8 max_rate_tries;
2895  	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2896  	u16 max_tx_aggregation_subframes;
2897  	u8 max_tx_fragments;
2898  	u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue;
2899  	u8 radiotap_mcs_details;
2900  	u16 radiotap_vht_details;
2901  	struct {
2902  		int units_pos;
2903  		s16 accuracy;
2904  	} radiotap_timestamp;
2905  	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
2906  	u8 uapsd_queues;
2907  	u8 uapsd_max_sp_len;
2908  	u8 max_nan_de_entries;
2909  	u8 tx_sk_pacing_shift;
2910  	u8 weight_multiplier;
2911  	u32 max_mtu;
2912  	const s8 *tx_power_levels;
2913  	u8 max_txpwr_levels_idx;
2914  };
2915  
_ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)2916  static inline bool _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2917  				       enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
2918  {
2919  	return test_bit(flg, hw->flags);
2920  }
2921  #define ieee80211_hw_check(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_check(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
2922  
_ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)2923  static inline void _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2924  				     enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
2925  {
2926  	return __set_bit(flg, hw->flags);
2927  }
2928  #define ieee80211_hw_set(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_set(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
2929  
2930  /**
2931   * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request
2932   *
2933   * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie)
2934   * @req: cfg80211 request.
2935   */
2936  struct ieee80211_scan_request {
2937  	struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies;
2938  
2939  	/* Keep last */
2940  	struct cfg80211_scan_request req;
2941  };
2942  
2943  /**
2944   * struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params - TDLS channel switch parameters
2945   *
2946   * @sta: peer this TDLS channel-switch request/response came from
2947   * @chandef: channel referenced in a TDLS channel-switch request
2948   * @action_code: see &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode
2949   * @status: channel-switch response status
2950   * @timestamp: time at which the frame was received
2951   * @switch_time: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
2952   * @switch_timeout: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
2953   * @tmpl_skb: TDLS switch-channel response template
2954   * @ch_sw_tm_ie: offset of the channel-switch timing IE inside @tmpl_skb
2955   */
2956  struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params {
2957  	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2958  	struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef;
2959  	u8 action_code;
2960  	u32 status;
2961  	u32 timestamp;
2962  	u16 switch_time;
2963  	u16 switch_timeout;
2964  	struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb;
2965  	u32 ch_sw_tm_ie;
2966  };
2967  
2968  /**
2969   * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy
2970   *
2971   * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query
2972   *
2973   * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective
2974   * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private
2975   * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should
2976   * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this
2977   * is already used internally by mac80211.
2978   *
2979   * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy.
2980   */
2981  struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy);
2982  
2983  /**
2984   * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware
2985   *
2986   * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for
2987   * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
2988   */
SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct device * dev)2989  static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev)
2990  {
2991  	set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev);
2992  }
2993  
2994  /**
2995   * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware
2996   *
2997   * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for
2998   * @addr: the address to set
2999   */
SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const u8 * addr)3000  static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, const u8 *addr)
3001  {
3002  	memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN);
3003  }
3004  
3005  static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c)3006  ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3007  		      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3008  {
3009  	if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0))
3010  		return NULL;
3011  	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx];
3012  }
3013  
3014  static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c)3015  ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3016  			   const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3017  {
3018  	if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0)
3019  		return NULL;
3020  	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx];
3021  }
3022  
3023  static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c,int idx)3024  ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3025  			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx)
3026  {
3027  	if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0)
3028  		return NULL;
3029  	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx];
3030  }
3031  
3032  /**
3033   * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb
3034   * @hw: the hardware
3035   * @skb: the skb
3036   *
3037   * Free a transmit skb. Use this function when some failure
3038   * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported.
3039   */
3040  void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
3041  
3042  /**
3043   * ieee80211_purge_tx_queue - purge TX skb queue
3044   * @hw: the hardware
3045   * @skbs: the skbs
3046   *
3047   * Free a set of transmit skbs. Use this function when device is going to stop
3048   * but some transmit skbs without TX status are still queued.
3049   * This function does not take the list lock and the caller must hold the
3050   * relevant locks to use it.
3051   */
3052  void ieee80211_purge_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3053  			      struct sk_buff_head *skbs);
3054  
3055  /**
3056   * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration
3057   *
3058   * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware
3059   * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations.
3060   *
3061   * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given
3062   * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and
3063   * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL
3064   * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to
3065   * the station information for the peer for individual keys.
3066   * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when
3067   * VLANs are configured for an access point.
3068   *
3069   * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx
3070   * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf
3071   * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function.
3072   *
3073   * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if
3074   * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be
3075   * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the
3076   * hardware key index, you are free to use the full u8 range.
3077   *
3078   * Note that in the case that the @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL flag is
3079   * set, mac80211 will not automatically fall back to software crypto if
3080   * enabling hardware crypto failed. The set_key() call may also return the
3081   * value 1 to permit this specific key/algorithm to be done in software.
3082   *
3083   * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed.
3084   *
3085   * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key
3086   * for it has been uploaded to hardware, the stack will not make any
3087   * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather
3088   * based on the receive flags.
3089   *
3090   * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key
3091   * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key()
3092   * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate
3093   * keys.
3094   *
3095   * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption
3096   * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key
3097   * handler.
3098   * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key.
3099   * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The
3100   * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did
3101   * rekeying), it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is
3102   * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this
3103   * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16.
3104   *
3105   * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index
3106   * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required
3107   * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses).
3108   *
3109   * Mac80211 drivers should set the @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0 flag
3110   * when they are able to replace in-use PTK keys according to the following
3111   * requirements:
3112   * 1) They do not hand over frames decrypted with the old key to mac80211
3113        once the call to set_key() with command %DISABLE_KEY has been completed,
3114     2) either drop or continue to use the old key for any outgoing frames queued
3115        at the time of the key deletion (including re-transmits),
3116     3) never send out a frame queued prior to the set_key() %SET_KEY command
3117        encrypted with the new key when also needing
3118        @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV and
3119     4) never send out a frame unencrypted when it should be encrypted.
3120     Mac80211 will not queue any new frames for a deleted key to the driver.
3121   */
3122  
3123  /**
3124   * DOC: Powersave support
3125   *
3126   * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations.
3127   *
3128   * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself,
3129   * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware
3130   * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode
3131   * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status.
3132   * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary,
3133   * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required
3134   * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when
3135   * it finds traffic directed to it.
3136   *
3137   * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in
3138   * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused
3139   * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking
3140   * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it
3141   * back to sleep at appropriate times.
3142   *
3143   * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the
3144   * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be
3145   * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame.
3146   *
3147   * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also
3148   * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported
3149   * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and
3150   * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still
3151   * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle
3152   * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that
3153   * as best as it can, mac80211 is too slow to do that.
3154   *
3155   * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the
3156   * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a
3157   * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to
3158   * the next wakeup. It's compromise of getting good enough latency when
3159   * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle
3160   * periods.
3161   *
3162   * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling
3163   * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS
3164   * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally,
3165   * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the
3166   * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support
3167   * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the
3168   * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value
3169   * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable
3170   * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS
3171   * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave.
3172   *
3173   * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling
3174   * %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the
3175   * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS
3176   * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To
3177   * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames
3178   * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled.
3179   *
3180   * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with
3181   * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK.
3182   */
3183  
3184  /**
3185   * DOC: Beacon filter support
3186   *
3187   * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups
3188   * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that
3189   * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly
3190   * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the
3191   * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That
3192   * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information
3193   * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed.
3194   *
3195   * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER
3196   * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support
3197   * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When
3198   * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the
3199   * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss().
3200   *
3201   * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the
3202   * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call
3203   * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled
3204   * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future.
3205   *
3206   * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing
3207   * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211
3208   * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense
3209   * that we want to see changes in them. This will include
3210   *
3211   *  - a list of information element IDs
3212   *  - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element
3213   *
3214   * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the
3215   * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense
3216   * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device
3217   * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all
3218   * vendor information elements.
3219   *
3220   * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information
3221   * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon.
3222   *
3223   * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead, just make sure nothing
3224   * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing
3225   * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and
3226   * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136,
3227   * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility
3228   * it could also include some currently unused IDs.
3229   *
3230   *
3231   * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the
3232   * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming
3233   * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of
3234   * the received data packets). This can consist in notifying the host when
3235   * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above
3236   * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be
3237   * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement
3238   * them as the roaming algorithm requires.
3239   *
3240   * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to
3241   * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the
3242   * signal strength threshold checking.
3243   */
3244  
3245  /**
3246   * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save
3247   *
3248   * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve
3249   * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism
3250   * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009)
3251   * "11.2.3 SM power save".
3252   *
3253   * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames
3254   * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct
3255   * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the
3256   * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware
3257   * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by
3258   * hardware flags.
3259   *
3260   * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211
3261   * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS
3262   * turned off otherwise.
3263   *
3264   * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate
3265   * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config()
3266   * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to
3267   * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP.
3268   */
3269  
3270  /**
3271   * DOC: Frame filtering
3272   *
3273   * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper
3274   * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when
3275   * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption,
3276   * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is
3277   * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible.
3278   *
3279   * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell
3280   * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be
3281   * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out.
3282   *
3283   * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast()
3284   * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list
3285   * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces.
3286   * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to
3287   * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the
3288   * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and
3289   * @total_flags with the new flag states.
3290   *
3291   * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will
3292   * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count
3293   * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted
3294   * or dropped.
3295   *
3296   * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared.
3297   * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_
3298   * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore
3299   * the flag, but not clear it.
3300   * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the
3301   * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type
3302   * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it).
3303   * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware
3304   * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes
3305   * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them,
3306   * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag.
3307   * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well.
3308   */
3309  
3310  /**
3311   * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients
3312   *
3313   * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for
3314   * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD.
3315   * There currently is no support for sAPSD.
3316   *
3317   * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client
3318   * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time.
3319   * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but
3320   * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies
3321   * the driver code.
3322   *
3323   * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete
3324   * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set,
3325   * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for
3326   * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames.
3327   * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of
3328   * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't
3329   * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD.
3330   *
3331   * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the
3332   * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a
3333   * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is,
3334   * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is
3335   * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this
3336   * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to
3337   * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will
3338   * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The
3339   * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its
3340   * @sta_notify callback.
3341   *
3342   * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up,
3343   * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period.
3344   * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and
3345   * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When
3346   * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211
3347   * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames
3348   * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit
3349   * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER
3350   * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only
3351   * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to
3352   * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have
3353   * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS.
3354   * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is
3355   * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer.
3356   *
3357   * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by
3358   * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them.
3359   *
3360   * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi
3361   * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up
3362   * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being
3363   * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong
3364   * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be
3365   * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to
3366   * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can
3367   * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it
3368   * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames
3369   * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again
3370   * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked.
3371   *
3372   * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any
3373   * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is
3374   * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any
3375   * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up
3376   * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when
3377   * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service
3378   * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called
3379   * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are
3380   * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting
3381   * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames,
3382   * to help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if
3383   * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames
3384   * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the
3385   * buffers for those TIDs contain.
3386   *
3387   * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may
3388   * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must
3389   * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that
3390   * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid
3391   * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released
3392   * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp()
3393   * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway.
3394   *
3395   * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211
3396   * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags
3397   * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
3398   * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame.
3399   * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case.
3400   *
3401   * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data
3402   * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as
3403   * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame
3404   * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed.
3405   */
3406  
3407  /**
3408   * DOC: HW queue control
3409   *
3410   * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static
3411   * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This
3412   * was problematic for a few reasons:
3413   * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames
3414   * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly
3415   * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames
3416   *
3417   * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all
3418   * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it
3419   * won't have the same problem with the software queues.
3420   *
3421   * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability
3422   * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do
3423   * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif
3424   * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will
3425   * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and
3426   * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors
3427   * the hardware queue.
3428   * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue
3429   * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.)
3430   *
3431   * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed, multiple virtual
3432   * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to
3433   * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a
3434   * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have
3435   * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios:
3436   *
3437   * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3
3438   * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7
3439   * after-DTIM queue for AP:   8
3440   * off-channel queue:         9
3441   *
3442   * It would then set up the hardware like this:
3443   *   hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9
3444   *
3445   * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows:
3446   *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0
3447   *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1
3448   *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2
3449   *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3
3450   *   vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3451   * and the second virtual interface with 4-7.
3452   *
3453   * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second
3454   * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC.
3455   *
3456   * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3457   * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the
3458   * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when
3459   * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode.
3460   */
3461  
3462  /**
3463   * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags
3464   *
3465   * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be
3466   * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the
3467   * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested,
3468   * but this has negative impact on power consumption.
3469   *
3470   * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested
3471   *	by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by
3472   *	multicast address.
3473   *
3474   * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the
3475   *	%RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them)
3476   *
3477   * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set
3478   *	the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them
3479   *
3480   * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate
3481   *	to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses
3482   *	by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing
3483   *	mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should
3484   *	honour this flag if possible.
3485   *
3486   * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll) addressed to this
3487   *	station
3488   *
3489   * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes
3490   *
3491   * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames
3492   *
3493   * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames
3494   *
3495   * @FIF_MCAST_ACTION: pass multicast Action frames
3496   */
3497  enum ieee80211_filter_flags {
3498  	FIF_ALLMULTI		= 1<<1,
3499  	FIF_FCSFAIL		= 1<<2,
3500  	FIF_PLCPFAIL		= 1<<3,
3501  	FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC	= 1<<4,
3502  	FIF_CONTROL		= 1<<5,
3503  	FIF_OTHER_BSS		= 1<<6,
3504  	FIF_PSPOLL		= 1<<7,
3505  	FIF_PROBE_REQ		= 1<<8,
3506  	FIF_MCAST_ACTION	= 1<<9,
3507  };
3508  
3509  /**
3510   * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions
3511   *
3512   * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in
3513   * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed.
3514   *
3515   * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation
3516   * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by
3517   * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer
3518   * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away!
3519   *
3520   * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation
3521   * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation
3522   * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation, the driver must either
3523   *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() or
3524   *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() with status
3525   *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA to delay addba after
3526   *	ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe is called, or just return the special
3527   *	status %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE.
3528   * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational
3529   * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting
3530   *	queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the
3531   *	driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe().
3532   * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets,
3533   *	called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call
3534   *	ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the
3535   *	session is gone and removes the station.
3536   * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped
3537   *	but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and
3538   *	now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers
3539   *	should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called.
3540   */
3541  enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action {
3542  	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START,
3543  	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP,
3544  	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START,
3545  	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT,
3546  	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH,
3547  	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT,
3548  	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL,
3549  };
3550  
3551  #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE 1
3552  #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA 2
3553  
3554  /**
3555   * struct ieee80211_ampdu_params - AMPDU action parameters
3556   *
3557   * @action: the ampdu action, value from %ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
3558   * @sta: peer of this AMPDU session
3559   * @tid: tid of the BA session
3560   * @ssn: start sequence number of the session. TX/RX_STOP can pass 0. When
3561   *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START the driver passes back the
3562   *	actual ssn value used to start the session and writes the value here.
3563   * @buf_size: reorder buffer size  (number of subframes). Valid only when the
3564   *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START or
3565   *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3566   * @amsdu: indicates the peer's ability to receive A-MSDU within A-MPDU.
3567   *	valid when the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3568   * @timeout: BA session timeout. Valid only when the action is set to
3569   *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START
3570   */
3571  struct ieee80211_ampdu_params {
3572  	enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action;
3573  	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3574  	u16 tid;
3575  	u16 ssn;
3576  	u16 buf_size;
3577  	bool amsdu;
3578  	u16 timeout;
3579  };
3580  
3581  /**
3582   * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason
3583   * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll
3584   * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to
3585   *	frame received on trigger-enabled AC
3586   */
3587  enum ieee80211_frame_release_type {
3588  	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL,
3589  	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD,
3590  };
3591  
3592  /**
3593   * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed
3594   *
3595   * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit
3596   *	to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station
3597   *	information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40
3598   *	flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes.
3599   * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed.
3600   * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer
3601   *	changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about
3602   *	the peer.
3603   * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed
3604   *	by the peer
3605   */
3606  enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed {
3607  	IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED		= BIT(0),
3608  	IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED	= BIT(1),
3609  	IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED	= BIT(2),
3610  	IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED	= BIT(3),
3611  };
3612  
3613  /**
3614   * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type
3615   *
3616   * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations,
3617   * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other
3618   * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vice versa).
3619   * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC
3620   * operations compared to other operations/flows.
3621   *
3622   * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC.
3623   * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required
3624   *	for sending management frames offchannel.
3625   */
3626  enum ieee80211_roc_type {
3627  	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0,
3628  	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX,
3629  };
3630  
3631  /**
3632   * enum ieee80211_reconfig_type - reconfig type
3633   *
3634   * This enum is used by the reconfig_complete() callback to indicate what
3635   * reconfiguration type was completed.
3636   *
3637   * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART: hw restart type
3638   *	(also due to resume() callback returning 1)
3639   * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND: suspend type (regardless
3640   *	of wowlan configuration)
3641   */
3642  enum ieee80211_reconfig_type {
3643  	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART,
3644  	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND,
3645  };
3646  
3647  /**
3648   * struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info - prepare TX information
3649   * @duration: if non-zero, hint about the required duration,
3650   *	only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method.
3651   * @subtype: frame subtype (auth, (re)assoc, deauth, disassoc)
3652   * @success: whether the frame exchange was successful, only
3653   *	used with the mgd_complete_tx() method, and then only
3654   *	valid for auth and (re)assoc.
3655   */
3656  struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info {
3657  	u16 duration;
3658  	u16 subtype;
3659  	u8 success:1;
3660  };
3661  
3662  /**
3663   * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver
3664   *
3665   * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may
3666   * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure
3667   * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame.
3668   *
3669   * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame.
3670   *	skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header.
3671   *	The low-level driver should send the frame out based on
3672   *	configuration in the TX control data. This handler should,
3673   *	preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately.
3674   *	Must be atomic.
3675   *
3676   * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware
3677   *	is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on
3678   *	frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.)
3679   *	Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace,
3680   *	or zero.
3681   *	When the device is started it should not have a MAC address
3682   *	to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device
3683   *	is added.
3684   *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3685   *
3686   * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware
3687   *	is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least
3688   *	it must turn off frame reception.)
3689   *	May be called right after add_interface if that rejects
3690   *	an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue
3691   *	you should ensure to cancel it on this callback.
3692   *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3693   *
3694   * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and
3695   *	stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then
3696   *	ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is
3697   *	configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and
3698   *	reconfigured at resume time.
3699   *	The driver may also impose special conditions under which it
3700   *	wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only
3701   *	supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it
3702   *	must return 1 from this function.
3703   *
3704   * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is
3705   *	now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully
3706   *	functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is
3707   *	to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211
3708   *	will also go through the regular complete restart on resume.
3709   *
3710   * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is
3711   *	modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is
3712   *	supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only
3713   *	in suspend().
3714   *
3715   * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is
3716   *	enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start
3717   *	and @stop must be implemented.
3718   *	The driver should perform any initialization it needs before
3719   *	the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the
3720   *	interface is given in the conf parameter.
3721   *	The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a
3722   *	negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.)
3723   *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3724   *
3725   * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback
3726   *	is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be
3727   *	switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep.
3728   *	Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be
3729   *	found by the interface iteration callbacks.
3730   *
3731   * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down.
3732   *	The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface
3733   *	and no monitor interfaces are present.
3734   *	When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware
3735   *	must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets,
3736   *	the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the
3737   *	MAC address of the device going away.
3738   *	Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep.
3739   *
3740   * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this
3741   *	function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel.
3742   *	This function should never fail but returns a negative error code
3743   *	if it does. The callback can sleep.
3744   *
3745   * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS
3746   *	parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low
3747   *	level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters).
3748   *	This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless
3749   *	for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which
3750   *	of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback
3751   *	can sleep.
3752   *	Note: this callback is called if @vif_cfg_changed or @link_info_changed
3753   *	are not implemented.
3754   *
3755   * @vif_cfg_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to interface
3756   *	(MLD) parameters from &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg that vary during the
3757   *	lifetime of the interface (e.g. assoc status, IP addresses, etc.)
3758   *	The @changed parameter indicates which value changed.
3759   *	The callback can sleep.
3760   *
3761   * @link_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to link
3762   *	parameters from &struct ieee80211_bss_conf that are related to an
3763   *	individual link. e.g. legacy/HT/VHT/... rate information.
3764   *	The @changed parameter indicates which value changed, and the @link_id
3765   *	parameter indicates the link ID. Note that the @link_id will be 0 for
3766   *	non-MLO connections.
3767   *	The callback can sleep.
3768   *
3769   * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration.
3770   *	This callback is optional, and its return value is passed
3771   *	to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic.
3772   *
3773   * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter.
3774   *	See the section "Frame filtering" for more information.
3775   *	This callback must be implemented and can sleep.
3776   *
3777   * @config_iface_filter: Configure the interface's RX filter.
3778   *	This callback is optional and is used to configure which frames
3779   *	should be passed to mac80211. The filter_flags is the combination
3780   *	of FIF_* flags. The changed_flags is a bit mask that indicates
3781   *	which flags are changed.
3782   *	This callback can sleep.
3783   *
3784   * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit
3785   * 	must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic.
3786   *
3787   * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3788   *	This callback is only called between add_interface and
3789   *	remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface
3790   *	is enabled.
3791   *	Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added.
3792   *	The callback can sleep.
3793   *
3794   * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3795   * 	This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers
3796   * 	which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY.
3797   *	The callback must be atomic.
3798   *
3799   * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the
3800   *	host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data
3801   *	necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter.
3802   *	After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify
3803   *	userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify().
3804   *
3805   * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for
3806   *	WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP
3807   *	offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it.
3808   *
3809   * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start
3810   *	the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel
3811   *	configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's
3812   *	registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure
3813   *	that power save is disabled.
3814   *	The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the
3815   *	entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these
3816   *	at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the
3817   *	(extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable).
3818   *	When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called;
3819   *	note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to
3820   *	any error unless this callback returned a negative error code.
3821   *	This callback is also allowed to return the special return value 1,
3822   *	this indicates that hardware scan isn't desirable right now and a
3823   *	software scan should be done instead. A driver wishing to use this
3824   *	capability must ensure its (hardware) scan capabilities aren't
3825   *	advertised as more capable than mac80211's software scan is.
3826   *	The callback can sleep.
3827   *
3828   * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan.
3829   *	The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible),
3830   *	but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call
3831   *	ieee80211_scan_completed().
3832   *	This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new
3833   *	scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended.
3834   *	The callback can sleep.
3835   *
3836   * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at
3837   *	specific intervals.  The driver must call the
3838   *	ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results.
3839   *	This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called.
3840   *
3841   * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan.
3842   *	In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called.
3843   *
3844   * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan
3845   *	is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification.
3846   *	The mac_addr parameter allows supporting NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR,
3847   *	the driver may set the NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR flag if it
3848   *	can use this parameter. The callback can sleep.
3849   *
3850   * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a
3851   *	software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need
3852   *	this notification.
3853   *	The callback can sleep.
3854   *
3855   * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics.
3856   * 	Returns zero if statistics are available.
3857   *	The callback can sleep.
3858   *
3859   * @get_key_seq: If your device implements encryption in hardware and does
3860   *	IV/PN assignment then this callback should be provided to read the
3861   *	IV/PN for the given key from hardware.
3862   *	The callback must be atomic.
3863   *
3864   * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this
3865   *	if the device does fragmentation by itself. Note that to prevent the
3866   *	stack from doing fragmentation IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG
3867   *	should be set as well.
3868   *	The callback can sleep.
3869   *
3870   * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it)
3871   *	The callback can sleep.
3872   *
3873   * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station,
3874   *	AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep.
3875   *
3876   * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated
3877   *	station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback
3878   *	returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected;
3879   *	no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing
3880   *	the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
3881   *	This callback can sleep.
3882   *
3883   * @link_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3884   *	when a link is added to a mac80211 vif. This callback should be within
3885   *	a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep.
3886   *	For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the default bss_conf
3887   *	with the vif's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
3888   *
3889   * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3890   *	when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback
3891   *	should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
3892   *	callback can sleep.
3893   *
3894   * @link_sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3895   *	when a link is added to a mac80211 station. This callback
3896   *	should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
3897   *	callback can sleep.
3898   *	For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the deflink with the
3899   *	station's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
3900   *
3901   * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an
3902   *	associated station, AP,  IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating
3903   *	in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag
3904   *	%IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic.
3905   *
3906   * @sta_set_txpwr: Configure the station tx power. This callback set the tx
3907   *	power for the station.
3908   *	This callback can sleep.
3909   *
3910   * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a
3911   *	station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.)
3912   *	This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove.
3913   *	It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions
3914   *	up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it
3915   *	isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace
3916   *	period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station.
3917   *	See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
3918   *	The callback can sleep.
3919   *
3920   * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU
3921   *	synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station
3922   *	pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear
3923   *	the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse
3924   *	in @sta_state.
3925   *	The callback can sleep.
3926   *
3927   * @sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can be
3928   *	used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits
3929   *	from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected
3930   *	in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver
3931   *	uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since
3932   *	otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly.
3933   *	Must be atomic.
3934   * @sta_rate_tbl_update: Notifies the driver that the rate table changed. This
3935   *	is only used if the configured rate control algorithm actually uses
3936   *	the new rate table API, and is therefore optional. Must be atomic.
3937   *
3938   * @sta_statistics: Get statistics for this station. For example with beacon
3939   *	filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be accurate, so
3940   *	let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can fill most of
3941   *	the values (indicating which by setting the filled bitmap), but not
3942   *	all of them make sense - see the source for which ones are possible.
3943   *	Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
3944   *	The callback can sleep.
3945   *
3946   * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max),
3947   *	bursting) for a hardware TX queue.
3948   *	Returns a negative error code on failure.
3949   *	The callback can sleep.
3950   *
3951   * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently,
3952   *	this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a
3953   *	required function.
3954   *	The callback can sleep.
3955   *
3956   * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware.
3957   *	Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a
3958   *	required function.
3959   *	The callback can sleep.
3960   *
3961   * @offset_tsf: Offset the TSF timer by the specified value in the
3962   *	firmware/hardware.  Preferred to set_tsf as it avoids delay between
3963   *	calling set_tsf() and hardware getting programmed, which will show up
3964   *	as TSF delay. Is not a required function.
3965   *	The callback can sleep.
3966   *
3967   * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize
3968   *	with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This
3969   *	function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of
3970   *	TSF synchronization.
3971   *	The callback can sleep.
3972   *
3973   * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us.
3974   *	This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is
3975   *	used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests.
3976   *	Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon.
3977   *	The callback can sleep.
3978   *
3979   * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information
3980   *
3981   * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also
3982   *	need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration,
3983   *	and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback.
3984   *	The callback can sleep.
3985   *
3986   * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified
3987   *	in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout
3988   *	accordingly; coverage class equals to -1 to enable ACK timeout
3989   *	estimation algorithm (dynack). To disable dynack set valid value for
3990   *	coverage class. This callback is not required and may sleep.
3991   *
3992   * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may
3993   *	be %NULL. The callback can sleep.
3994   * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep.
3995   *
3996   * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure
3997   *	that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap
3998   *	of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces
3999   *	use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues.
4000   *	If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped.
4001   *	Note that vif can be NULL.
4002   *	The callback can sleep.
4003   *
4004   * @flush_sta: Flush or drop all pending frames from the hardware queue(s) for
4005   *	the given station, as it's about to be removed.
4006   *	The callback can sleep.
4007   *
4008   * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel
4009   *	switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this
4010   *	callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate
4011   *	completion of the channel switch.
4012   *
4013   * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
4014   *	Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
4015   *	reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
4016   *	(also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
4017   *
4018   * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
4019   *
4020   * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must
4021   *	call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note
4022   *	that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw
4023   *	offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted
4024   *	normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the
4025   *	duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call
4026   *	ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired().
4027   *	Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and
4028   *	must be accepted in this case.
4029   *	This callback may sleep.
4030   * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is
4031   *	aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep.
4032   *
4033   * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes.
4034   *
4035   * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes.
4036   *
4037   * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware
4038   *	queues before entering power save.
4039   *
4040   * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection
4041   *	when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled.
4042   *	The callback can sleep.
4043   * @event_callback: Notify driver about any event in mac80211. See
4044   *	&enum ieee80211_event_type for the different types.
4045   *	The callback must be atomic.
4046   *
4047   * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given
4048   *	parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for
4049   *	sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver
4050   *	to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD.
4051   *	Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check
4052   *	if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than
4053   *	the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in
4054   *	the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the
4055   *	more-data bit must always be set.
4056   *	The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames
4057   *	from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set.
4058   *	In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the
4059   *	@num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In
4060   *	this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4061   *	on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll
4062   *	period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple
4063   *	responses for a retried PS-poll frame.
4064   *	In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be
4065   *	bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send
4066   *	at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for
4067   *	setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the
4068   *	service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP
4069   *	on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function
4070   *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP.
4071   *	This callback must be atomic.
4072   * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames
4073   *	to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211
4074   *	via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames
4075   *	released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set
4076   *	and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case
4077   *	frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder
4078   *	them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4079   *	on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP
4080   *	bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the
4081   *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() function.
4082   *	The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the
4083   *	frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set.
4084   *	This callback must be atomic.
4085   *
4086   * @get_et_sset_count:  Ethtool API to get string-set count.
4087   *
4088   * @get_et_stats:  Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats.
4089   *
4090   * @get_et_strings:  Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats
4091   *	and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets.
4092   *
4093   * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association
4094   *	before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is
4095   *	bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated
4096   *	yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any
4097   *	transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's
4098   *	powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a
4099   *	management frame prior to having successfully associated to allow the
4100   *	driver to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response
4101   *	and to be able to synchronize with the GO.
4102   *	For drivers that set %IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP, mac80211
4103   *	would also call this function before transmitting a deauthentication
4104   *	frame in case that no beacon was heard from the AP/P2P GO.
4105   *	The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return
4106   *	mac80211 will transmit the frame right away.
4107   *	Additional information is passed in the &struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info
4108   *	data. If duration there is greater than zero, mac80211 hints to the
4109   *	driver the duration for which the operation is requested.
4110   *	The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep.
4111   * @mgd_complete_tx: Notify the driver that the response frame for a previously
4112   *	transmitted frame announced with @mgd_prepare_tx was received, the data
4113   *	is filled similarly to @mgd_prepare_tx though the duration is not used.
4114   *
4115   * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending
4116   *	a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's
4117   *	channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS
4118   *	setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP.
4119   *	mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS
4120   *	discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least
4121   *	2 * (DTIM period).
4122   *	The callback is optional and can sleep.
4123   *
4124   * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation.
4125   *	This callback may sleep.
4126   * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction.
4127   *	This callback may sleep.
4128   * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that
4129   *	may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same
4130   *	channel context with different settings
4131   *	This callback may sleep.
4132   * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound
4133   *	to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping.
4134   *	This callback may sleep.
4135   * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being
4136   *	unbound from vif.
4137   *	This callback may sleep.
4138   * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to
4139   *	another, as specified in the list of
4140   *	@ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according
4141   *	to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode.
4142   *	This callback may sleep.
4143   *
4144   * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the
4145   *	information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel
4146   *	context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses
4147   *	software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is
4148   *	just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being
4149   *	disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed.
4150   * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface.
4151   *
4152   * @reconfig_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw() and
4153   *	during resume, when the reconfiguration has completed.
4154   *	This can help the driver implement the reconfiguration step (and
4155   *	indicate mac80211 is ready to receive frames).
4156   *	This callback may sleep.
4157   *
4158   * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed.
4159   *	Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces.
4160   *	This callback is optional; it must not sleep.
4161   *
4162   * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel.
4163   *	Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this
4164   *	function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be
4165   *	decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call
4166   *	ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get()
4167   *	get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is
4168   *	1 using ieee80211_beacon_counter_is_complete() after the beacon has been
4169   *	transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish().
4170   *	If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called,
4171   *	since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway.
4172   * @pre_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4173   *	before a channel switch procedure is started (ie. when a STA
4174   *	gets a CSA or a userspace initiated channel-switch), allowing
4175   *	the driver to prepare for the channel switch.
4176   * @post_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4177   *	after a channel switch procedure is completed, allowing the
4178   *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4179   * @abort_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4180   *	when channel switch procedure was completed, allowing the
4181   *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4182   * @channel_switch_rx_beacon: This is an optional callback that is called
4183   *	when channel switch procedure is in progress and additional beacon with
4184   *	CSA IE was received, allowing driver to track changes in count.
4185   * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all
4186   *	information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A
4187   *	channel context is bound before this is called.
4188   * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again.
4189   *
4190   * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the
4191   *	specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0
4192   *	if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide.
4193   *
4194   * @get_txpower: get current maximum tx power (in dBm) based on configuration
4195   *	and hardware limits.
4196   *
4197   * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
4198   *	is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
4199   *	and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. The
4200   *	driver receives a channel-switch request template and the location of
4201   *	the switch-timing IE within the template as part of the invocation.
4202   *	The template is valid only within the call, and the driver can
4203   *	optionally copy the skb for further re-use.
4204   * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
4205   *	peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
4206   * @tdls_recv_channel_switch: a TDLS channel-switch related frame (request or
4207   *	response) has been received from a remote peer. The driver gets
4208   *	parameters parsed from the incoming frame and may use them to continue
4209   *	an ongoing channel-switch operation. In addition, a channel-switch
4210   *	response template is provided, together with the location of the
4211   *	switch-timing IE within the template. The skb can only be used within
4212   *	the function call.
4213   *
4214   * @wake_tx_queue: Called when new packets have been added to the queue.
4215   * @sync_rx_queues: Process all pending frames in RSS queues. This is a
4216   *	synchronization which is needed in case driver has in its RSS queues
4217   *	pending frames that were received prior to the control path action
4218   *	currently taken (e.g. disassociation) but are not processed yet.
4219   *
4220   * @start_nan: join an existing NAN cluster, or create a new one.
4221   * @stop_nan: leave the NAN cluster.
4222   * @nan_change_conf: change NAN configuration. The data in cfg80211_nan_conf
4223   *	contains full new configuration and changes specify which parameters
4224   *	are changed with respect to the last NAN config.
4225   *	The driver gets both full configuration and the changed parameters since
4226   *	some devices may need the full configuration while others need only the
4227   *	changed parameters.
4228   * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns 0 on success. The data in
4229   *	cfg80211_nan_func must not be referenced outside the scope of
4230   *	this call.
4231   * @del_nan_func: Remove a NAN function. The driver must call
4232   *	ieee80211_nan_func_terminated() with
4233   *	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST reason code upon removal.
4234   * @can_aggregate_in_amsdu: Called in order to determine if HW supports
4235   *	aggregating two specific frames in the same A-MSDU. The relation
4236   *	between the skbs should be symmetric and transitive. Note that while
4237   *	skb is always a real frame, head may or may not be an A-MSDU.
4238   * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
4239   *	Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
4240   *
4241   * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) (this call can sleep)
4242   * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement (this call can sleep)
4243   * @set_tid_config: Apply TID specific configurations. This callback may sleep.
4244   * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer.
4245   *	This callback may sleep.
4246   * @update_vif_offload: Update virtual interface offload flags
4247   *	This callback may sleep.
4248   * @sta_set_4addr: Called to notify the driver when a station starts/stops using
4249   *	4-address mode
4250   * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
4251   * @sta_set_decap_offload: Called to notify the driver when a station is allowed
4252   *	to use rx decapsulation offload
4253   * @add_twt_setup: Update hw with TWT agreement parameters received from the peer.
4254   *	This callback allows the hw to check if requested parameters
4255   *	are supported and if there is enough room for a new agreement.
4256   *	The hw is expected to set agreement result in the req_type field of
4257   *	twt structure.
4258   * @twt_teardown_request: Update the hw with TWT teardown request received
4259   *	from the peer.
4260   * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
4261   *	radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
4262   *	or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
4263   *	Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
4264   *	switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
4265   *	radar channel.
4266   *	The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
4267   *	disable background CAC/radar detection.
4268   * @net_fill_forward_path: Called from .ndo_fill_forward_path in order to
4269   *	resolve a path for hardware flow offloading
4270   * @change_vif_links: Change the valid links on an interface, note that while
4271   *	removing the old link information is still valid (link_conf pointer),
4272   *	but may immediately disappear after the function returns. The old or
4273   *	new links bitmaps may be 0 if going from/to a non-MLO situation.
4274   *	The @old array contains pointers to the old bss_conf structures
4275   *	that were already removed, in case they're needed.
4276   *	This callback can sleep.
4277   * @change_sta_links: Change the valid links of a station, similar to
4278   *	@change_vif_links. This callback can sleep.
4279   *	Note that a sta can also be inserted or removed with valid links,
4280   *	i.e. passed to @sta_add/@sta_state with sta->valid_links not zero.
4281   *	In fact, cannot change from having valid_links and not having them.
4282   * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames. This is
4283   *	not restored at HW reset by mac80211 so drivers need to take care of
4284   *	that.
4285   * @net_setup_tc: Called from .ndo_setup_tc in order to prepare hardware
4286   *	flow offloading for flows originating from the vif.
4287   *	Note that the driver must not assume that the vif driver_data is valid
4288   *	at this point, since the callback can be called during netdev teardown.
4289   */
4290  struct ieee80211_ops {
4291  	void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4292  		   struct ieee80211_tx_control *control,
4293  		   struct sk_buff *skb);
4294  	int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4295  	void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4296  #ifdef CONFIG_PM
4297  	int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan);
4298  	int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4299  	void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled);
4300  #endif
4301  	int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4302  			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4303  	int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4304  				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4305  				enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p);
4306  	void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4307  				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4308  	int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 changed);
4309  	void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4310  				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4311  				 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4312  				 u64 changed);
4313  	void (*vif_cfg_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4314  				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4315  				u64 changed);
4316  	void (*link_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4317  				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4318  				  struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4319  				  u64 changed);
4320  
4321  	int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4322  			struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4323  	void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4324  			struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4325  
4326  	u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4327  				 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list);
4328  	void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4329  				 unsigned int changed_flags,
4330  				 unsigned int *total_flags,
4331  				 u64 multicast);
4332  	void (*config_iface_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4333  				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4334  				    unsigned int filter_flags,
4335  				    unsigned int changed_flags);
4336  	int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4337  		       bool set);
4338  	int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd,
4339  		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4340  		       struct ieee80211_key_conf *key);
4341  	void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4342  				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4343  				struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf,
4344  				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4345  				u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key);
4346  	void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4347  			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4348  			       struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4349  	void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4350  					struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx);
4351  	int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4352  		       struct ieee80211_scan_request *req);
4353  	void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4354  			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4355  	int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4356  				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4357  				struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req,
4358  				struct ieee80211_scan_ies *ies);
4359  	int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4360  			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4361  	void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4362  			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4363  			      const u8 *mac_addr);
4364  	void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4365  				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4366  	int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4367  			 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats);
4368  	void (*get_key_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4369  			    struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
4370  			    struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
4371  	int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4372  	int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4373  	int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4374  		       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4375  	int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4376  			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4377  #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
4378  	void (*link_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4379  				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4380  				 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4381  				 struct dentry *dir);
4382  	void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4383  				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4384  				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4385  				struct dentry *dir);
4386  	void (*link_sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4387  				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4388  				     struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4389  				     struct dentry *dir);
4390  #endif
4391  	void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4392  			enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4393  	int (*sta_set_txpwr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4394  			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4395  			     struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4396  	int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4397  			 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4398  			 enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state,
4399  			 enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state);
4400  	void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4401  				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4402  				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4403  	void (*sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4404  			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4405  			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4406  			      u32 changed);
4407  	void (*sta_rate_tbl_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4408  				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4409  				    struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4410  	void (*sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4411  			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4412  			       struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4413  			       struct station_info *sinfo);
4414  	int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4415  		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4416  		       unsigned int link_id, u16 ac,
4417  		       const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params);
4418  	u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4419  	void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4420  			u64 tsf);
4421  	void (*offset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4422  			   s64 offset);
4423  	void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4424  	int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4425  
4426  	/**
4427  	 * @ampdu_action:
4428  	 * Perform a certain A-MPDU action.
4429  	 * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want
4430  	 * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through
4431  	 * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
4432  	 * When the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL the driver
4433  	 * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than @buf_size
4434  	 * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the
4435  	 * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be
4436  	 * possible with a buf_size of 8:
4437  	 *
4438  	 * - ``TX: 1.....7``
4439  	 * - ``RX:  2....7`` (lost frame #1)
4440  	 * - ``TX:        8..1...``
4441  	 *
4442  	 * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the
4443  	 * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be:
4444  	 *
4445  	 * - ``TX:        1   or``
4446  	 * - ``TX:        18  or``
4447  	 * - ``TX:        81``
4448  	 *
4449  	 * Even ``189`` would be wrong since 1 could be lost again.
4450  	 *
4451  	 * Returns a negative error code on failure. The driver may return
4452  	 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE for %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START
4453  	 * if the session can start immediately.
4454  	 *
4455  	 * The callback can sleep.
4456  	 */
4457  	int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4458  			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4459  			    struct ieee80211_ampdu_params *params);
4460  	int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx,
4461  		struct survey_info *survey);
4462  	void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4463  	void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, s16 coverage_class);
4464  #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4465  	int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4466  			    void *data, int len);
4467  	int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb,
4468  			     struct netlink_callback *cb,
4469  			     void *data, int len);
4470  #endif
4471  	void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4472  		      u32 queues, bool drop);
4473  	void (*flush_sta)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4474  			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4475  	void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4476  			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4477  			       struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4478  	int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4479  	int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4480  
4481  	int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4482  				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4483  				 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4484  				 int duration,
4485  				 enum ieee80211_roc_type type);
4486  	int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4487  					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4488  	int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx);
4489  	void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4490  			      u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max);
4491  	bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4492  	int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4493  				const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4494  	void (*event_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4495  			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4496  			       const struct ieee80211_event *event);
4497  
4498  	void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4499  				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4500  				      u16 tids, int num_frames,
4501  				      enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4502  				      bool more_data);
4503  	void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4504  					struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4505  					u16 tids, int num_frames,
4506  					enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4507  					bool more_data);
4508  
4509  	int	(*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4510  				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset);
4511  	void	(*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4512  				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4513  				struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data);
4514  	void	(*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4515  				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4516  				  u32 sset, u8 *data);
4517  
4518  	void	(*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4519  				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4520  				  struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4521  	void	(*mgd_complete_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4522  				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4523  				   struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4524  
4525  	void	(*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4526  					     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4527  
4528  	int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4529  			   struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4530  	void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4531  			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4532  	void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4533  			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
4534  			       u32 changed);
4535  	int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4536  				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4537  				  struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4538  				  struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4539  	void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4540  				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4541  				     struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4542  				     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4543  	int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4544  				  struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
4545  				  int n_vifs,
4546  				  enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
4547  
4548  	void (*reconfig_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4549  				  enum ieee80211_reconfig_type reconfig_type);
4550  
4551  #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6)
4552  	void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4553  				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4554  				 struct inet6_dev *idev);
4555  #endif
4556  	void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4557  				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4558  				      struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4559  	int (*pre_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4560  				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4561  				  struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4562  
4563  	int (*post_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4564  				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4565  	void (*abort_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4566  				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4567  	void (*channel_switch_rx_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4568  					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4569  					 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4570  
4571  	int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4572  	void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4573  	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4574  				       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4575  	int (*get_txpower)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4576  			   int *dbm);
4577  
4578  	int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4579  				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4580  				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 oper_class,
4581  				   struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4582  				   struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb, u32 ch_sw_tm_ie);
4583  	void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4584  					   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4585  					   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4586  	void (*tdls_recv_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4587  					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4588  					 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params *params);
4589  
4590  	void (*wake_tx_queue)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4591  			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
4592  	void (*sync_rx_queues)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4593  
4594  	int (*start_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4595  			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4596  			 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4597  	int (*stop_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4598  			struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4599  	int (*nan_change_conf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4600  			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4601  			       struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, u32 changes);
4602  	int (*add_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4603  			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4604  			    const struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4605  	void (*del_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4606  			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4607  			    u8 instance_id);
4608  	bool (*can_aggregate_in_amsdu)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4609  				       struct sk_buff *head,
4610  				       struct sk_buff *skb);
4611  	int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4612  				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4613  				       struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4614  	int (*start_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4615  			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4616  	void (*abort_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4617  			   struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4618  	int (*set_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4619  			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4620  			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4621  			      struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4622  	int (*reset_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4623  				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4624  				struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tids);
4625  	void (*update_vif_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4626  				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4627  	void (*sta_set_4addr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4628  			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4629  	int (*set_sar_specs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4630  			     const struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4631  	void (*sta_set_decap_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4632  				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4633  				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4634  	void (*add_twt_setup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4635  			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4636  			      struct ieee80211_twt_setup *twt);
4637  	void (*twt_teardown_request)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4638  				     struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 flowid);
4639  	int (*set_radar_background)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4640  				    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4641  	int (*net_fill_forward_path)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4642  				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4643  				     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4644  				     struct net_device_path_ctx *ctx,
4645  				     struct net_device_path *path);
4646  	int (*change_vif_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4647  				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4648  				u16 old_links, u16 new_links,
4649  				struct ieee80211_bss_conf *old[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]);
4650  	int (*change_sta_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4651  				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4652  				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4653  				u16 old_links, u16 new_links);
4654  	int (*set_hw_timestamp)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4655  				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4656  				struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts);
4657  	int (*net_setup_tc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4658  			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4659  			    struct net_device *dev,
4660  			    enum tc_setup_type type,
4661  			    void *type_data);
4662  };
4663  
4664  /**
4665   * ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm - Allocate a new hardware device
4666   *
4667   * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4668   * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4669   * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4670   * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4671   * @priv_data_len.
4672   *
4673   * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4674   * @ops: callbacks for this device
4675   * @requested_name: Requested name for this device.
4676   *	NULL is valid value, and means use the default naming (phy%d)
4677   *
4678   * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4679   */
4680  struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(size_t priv_data_len,
4681  					   const struct ieee80211_ops *ops,
4682  					   const char *requested_name);
4683  
4684  /**
4685   * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device
4686   *
4687   * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4688   * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4689   * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4690   * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4691   * @priv_data_len.
4692   *
4693   * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4694   * @ops: callbacks for this device
4695   *
4696   * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4697   */
4698  static inline
ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,const struct ieee80211_ops * ops)4699  struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,
4700  					const struct ieee80211_ops *ops)
4701  {
4702  	return ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(priv_data_len, ops, NULL);
4703  }
4704  
4705  /**
4706   * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device
4707   *
4708   * You must call this function before any other functions in
4709   * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you
4710   * need to fill the contained wiphy's information.
4711   *
4712   * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw()
4713   *
4714   * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
4715   */
4716  int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4717  
4718  /**
4719   * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description
4720   * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec
4721   * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds
4722   *	(full cycle, ie. one off + one on period)
4723   */
4724  struct ieee80211_tpt_blink {
4725  	int throughput;
4726  	int blink_time;
4727  };
4728  
4729  /**
4730   * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags
4731   * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio
4732   * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working
4733   * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one
4734   *	interface is connected in some way, including being an AP
4735   */
4736  enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags {
4737  	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO		= BIT(0),
4738  	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK		= BIT(1),
4739  	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED	= BIT(2),
4740  };
4741  
4742  #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4743  const char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4744  const char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4745  const char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4746  const char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4747  const char *
4748  __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4749  				   unsigned int flags,
4750  				   const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4751  				   unsigned int blink_table_len);
4752  #endif
4753  /**
4754   * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED
4755   *
4756   * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4757   * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4758   * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4759   * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4760   *
4761   * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4762   *
4763   * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4764   */
ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)4765  static inline const char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4766  {
4767  #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4768  	return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw);
4769  #else
4770  	return NULL;
4771  #endif
4772  }
4773  
4774  /**
4775   * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED
4776   *
4777   * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4778   * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4779   * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4780   * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4781   *
4782   * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4783   *
4784   * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4785   */
ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)4786  static inline const char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4787  {
4788  #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4789  	return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw);
4790  #else
4791  	return NULL;
4792  #endif
4793  }
4794  
4795  /**
4796   * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED
4797   *
4798   * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4799   * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4800   * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4801   * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4802   *
4803   * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4804   *
4805   * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4806   */
ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)4807  static inline const char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4808  {
4809  #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4810  	return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw);
4811  #else
4812  	return NULL;
4813  #endif
4814  }
4815  
4816  /**
4817   * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED
4818   *
4819   * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4820   * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4821   * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4822   * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4823   *
4824   * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4825   *
4826   * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4827   */
ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)4828  static inline const char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4829  {
4830  #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4831  	return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw);
4832  #else
4833  	return NULL;
4834  #endif
4835  }
4836  
4837  /**
4838   * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger
4839   * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for
4840   * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags
4841   * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput
4842   * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table
4843   *
4844   * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are
4845   * configured) or the name of the new trigger.
4846   *
4847   * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw().
4848   */
4849  static inline const char *
ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,unsigned int flags,const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink * blink_table,unsigned int blink_table_len)4850  ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags,
4851  				 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4852  				 unsigned int blink_table_len)
4853  {
4854  #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4855  	return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table,
4856  						  blink_table_len);
4857  #else
4858  	return NULL;
4859  #endif
4860  }
4861  
4862  /**
4863   * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device
4864   *
4865   * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources
4866   * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem.
4867   *
4868   * @hw: the hardware to unregister
4869   */
4870  void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4871  
4872  /**
4873   * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor
4874   *
4875   * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the
4876   * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw()
4877   * before calling this function.
4878   *
4879   * @hw: the hardware to free
4880   */
4881  void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4882  
4883  /**
4884   * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely
4885   *
4886   * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason
4887   * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state
4888   * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware
4889   * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by
4890   * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all
4891   * internal state that it has prior to calling this function.
4892   *
4893   * @hw: the hardware to restart
4894   */
4895  void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4896  
4897  /**
4898   * ieee80211_rx_list - receive frame and store processed skbs in a list
4899   *
4900   * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4901   * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4902   * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4903   * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4904   * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4905   *
4906   * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4907   * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4908   * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4909   * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4910   * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4911   *
4912   * This function must be called with BHs disabled and RCU read lock
4913   *
4914   * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4915   * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
4916   * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4917   * @list: the destination list
4918   */
4919  void ieee80211_rx_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4920  		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct list_head *list);
4921  
4922  /**
4923   * ieee80211_rx_napi - receive frame from NAPI context
4924   *
4925   * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4926   * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4927   * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4928   * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4929   * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4930   *
4931   * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4932   * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4933   * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4934   * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4935   * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4936   *
4937   * This function must be called with BHs disabled.
4938   *
4939   * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4940   * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
4941   * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4942   * @napi: the NAPI context
4943   */
4944  void ieee80211_rx_napi(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4945  		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct napi_struct *napi);
4946  
4947  /**
4948   * ieee80211_rx - receive frame
4949   *
4950   * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4951   * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4952   * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4953   * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4954   * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4955   *
4956   * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4957   * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4958   * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4959   * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4960   * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4961   *
4962   * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni().
4963   *
4964   * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4965   * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4966   */
ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)4967  static inline void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb)
4968  {
4969  	ieee80211_rx_napi(hw, NULL, skb, NULL);
4970  }
4971  
4972  /**
4973   * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame
4974   *
4975   * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context
4976   * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
4977   *
4978   * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not
4979   * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with
4980   * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4981   *
4982   * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4983   * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4984   */
4985  void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
4986  
4987  /**
4988   * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context)
4989   *
4990   * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context
4991   * (internally disables bottom halves).
4992   *
4993   * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may
4994   * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4995   * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4996   *
4997   * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4998   * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4999   */
ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)5000  static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5001  				   struct sk_buff *skb)
5002  {
5003  	local_bh_disable();
5004  	ieee80211_rx(hw, skb);
5005  	local_bh_enable();
5006  }
5007  
5008  /**
5009   * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta
5010   *
5011   * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS
5012   * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station
5013   * entering/leaving PS mode.
5014   *
5015   * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled.
5016   *
5017   * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against
5018   * each other.
5019   *
5020   * @sta: currently connected sta
5021   * @start: start or stop PS
5022   *
5023   * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set.
5024   */
5025  int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start);
5026  
5027  /**
5028   * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta
5029   *                                  (in process context)
5030   *
5031   * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context
5032   * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still
5033   * applies.
5034   *
5035   * @sta: currently connected sta
5036   * @start: start or stop PS
5037   *
5038   * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition().
5039   */
ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta * sta,bool start)5040  static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5041  						  bool start)
5042  {
5043  	int ret;
5044  
5045  	local_bh_disable();
5046  	ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start);
5047  	local_bh_enable();
5048  
5049  	return ret;
5050  }
5051  
5052  /**
5053   * ieee80211_sta_pspoll - PS-Poll frame received
5054   * @sta: currently connected station
5055   *
5056   * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5057   * use this function to inform mac80211 that a PS-Poll frame from a
5058   * connected station was received.
5059   * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5060   * and possibly ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(); calls to all three must
5061   * be serialized.
5062   */
5063  void ieee80211_sta_pspoll(struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
5064  
5065  /**
5066   * ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger - (potential) U-APSD trigger frame received
5067   * @sta: currently connected station
5068   * @tid: TID of the received (potential) trigger frame
5069   *
5070   * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5071   * use this function to inform mac80211 that a (potential) trigger frame
5072   * from a connected station was received.
5073   * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5074   * and possibly ieee80211_sta_pspoll(); calls to all three must be
5075   * serialized.
5076   * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS can be passed as the tid if the tid is unknown.
5077   * In this case, mac80211 will not check that this tid maps to an AC
5078   * that is trigger enabled and assume that the caller did the proper
5079   * checks.
5080   */
5081  void ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
5082  
5083  /*
5084   * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions.
5085   * This is enough for the radiotap header.
5086   */
5087  #define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM	ALIGN(14, 4)
5088  
5089  /**
5090   * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames
5091   * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station
5092   * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames
5093   * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID
5094   *
5095   * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing
5096   * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need
5097   * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit.
5098   *
5099   * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are
5100   * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data
5101   * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim
5102   * call! Beware of the locking!)
5103   *
5104   * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD)
5105   * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are
5106   * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes
5107   * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data,
5108   * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered
5109   * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP).
5110   *
5111   * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per
5112   * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since
5113   * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the
5114   * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that
5115   * use this API.
5116   */
5117  void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5118  				u8 tid, bool buffered);
5119  
5120  /**
5121   * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet
5122   *
5123   * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support
5124   * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent
5125   * rate selection table for the station entry.
5126   *
5127   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5128   * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent.
5129   * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
5130   * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information
5131   * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch
5132   */
5133  void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5134  			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5135  			    struct sk_buff *skb,
5136  			    struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest,
5137  			    int max_rates);
5138  
5139  /**
5140   * ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput - set the expected tpt for a station
5141   *
5142   * Call this function to notify mac80211 about a change in expected throughput
5143   * to a station. A driver for a device that does rate control in firmware can
5144   * call this function when the expected throughput estimate towards a station
5145   * changes. The information is used to tune the CoDel AQM applied to traffic
5146   * going towards that station (which can otherwise be too aggressive and cause
5147   * slow stations to starve).
5148   *
5149   * @pubsta: the station to set throughput for.
5150   * @thr: the current expected throughput in kbps.
5151   */
5152  void ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5153  					   u32 thr);
5154  
5155  /**
5156   * ieee80211_tx_rate_update - transmit rate update callback
5157   *
5158   * Drivers should call this functions with a non-NULL pub sta
5159   * This function can be used in drivers that does not have provision
5160   * in updating the tx rate in data path.
5161   *
5162   * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5163   * @pubsta: the station to update the tx rate for.
5164   * @info: tx status information
5165   */
5166  void ieee80211_tx_rate_update(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5167  			      struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5168  			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info);
5169  
5170  /**
5171   * ieee80211_tx_status - transmit status callback
5172   *
5173   * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been
5174   * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for
5175   * multicast frames but this can affect statistics.
5176   *
5177   * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5178   * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls
5179   * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe()
5180   * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5181   * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni().
5182   *
5183   * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5184   * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5185   */
5186  void ieee80211_tx_status(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5187  			 struct sk_buff *skb);
5188  
5189  /**
5190   * ieee80211_tx_status_ext - extended transmit status callback
5191   *
5192   * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status
5193   * in drivers that may want to provide extra information that does not
5194   * fit into &struct ieee80211_tx_info.
5195   *
5196   * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5197   * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5198   * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5199   *
5200   * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5201   * @status: tx status information
5202   */
5203  void ieee80211_tx_status_ext(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5204  			     struct ieee80211_tx_status *status);
5205  
5206  /**
5207   * ieee80211_tx_status_noskb - transmit status callback without skb
5208   *
5209   * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status
5210   * in drivers that cannot reliably map tx status information back to
5211   * specific skbs.
5212   *
5213   * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5214   * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5215   * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5216   *
5217   * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5218   * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent
5219   *	(NULL for multicast packets)
5220   * @info: tx status information
5221   */
ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_sta * sta,struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)5222  static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5223  					     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5224  					     struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
5225  {
5226  	struct ieee80211_tx_status status = {
5227  		.sta = sta,
5228  		.info = info,
5229  	};
5230  
5231  	ieee80211_tx_status_ext(hw, &status);
5232  }
5233  
5234  /**
5235   * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context)
5236   *
5237   * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in process context.
5238   *
5239   * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and
5240   * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed
5241   * for a single hardware.
5242   *
5243   * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5244   * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5245   */
ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)5246  static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5247  					  struct sk_buff *skb)
5248  {
5249  	local_bh_disable();
5250  	ieee80211_tx_status(hw, skb);
5251  	local_bh_enable();
5252  }
5253  
5254  /**
5255   * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback
5256   *
5257   * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in IRQ context
5258   * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5259   *
5260   * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and
5261   * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5262   *
5263   * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5264   * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5265   */
5266  void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5267  				 struct sk_buff *skb);
5268  
5269  /**
5270   * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station
5271   *
5272   * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding
5273   * connected STA.
5274   *
5275   * @sta: the non-responding connected sta
5276   * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response
5277   */
5278  void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets);
5279  
5280  #define IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM 2
5281  
5282  /**
5283   * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets
5284   * @tim_offset: position of TIM element
5285   * @tim_length: size of TIM element
5286   * @cntdwn_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM offsets
5287   *	to countdown counters.  This array can contain zero values which
5288   *	should be ignored.
5289   * @mbssid_off: position of the multiple bssid element
5290   */
5291  struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets {
5292  	u16 tim_offset;
5293  	u16 tim_length;
5294  
5295  	u16 cntdwn_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM];
5296  	u16 mbssid_off;
5297  };
5298  
5299  /**
5300   * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function
5301   * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5302   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5303   * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5304   *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5305   * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5306   *	that is not associated with AP MLD).
5307   *
5308   * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5309   * obtain the beacon template.
5310   *
5311   * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the
5312   * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template
5313   * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when
5314   * applicable, the CSA count.
5315   *
5316   * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5317   *
5318   * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5319   */
5320  struct sk_buff *
5321  ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5322  			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5323  			      struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5324  			      unsigned int link_id);
5325  
5326  /**
5327   * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index - EMA beacon template generation
5328   * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5329   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5330   * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5331   *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5332   * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP).
5333   * @ema_index: index of the beacon in the EMA set.
5334   *
5335   * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5336   * but returns a beacon template which includes multiple BSSID element at the
5337   * requested index.
5338   *
5339   * Return: The beacon template. %NULL indicates the end of EMA templates.
5340   */
5341  struct sk_buff *
5342  ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5343  					struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5344  					struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5345  					unsigned int link_id, u8 ema_index);
5346  
5347  /**
5348   * struct ieee80211_ema_beacons - List of EMA beacons
5349   * @cnt: count of EMA beacons.
5350   *
5351   * @bcn: array of EMA beacons.
5352   * @bcn.skb: the skb containing this specific beacon
5353   * @bcn.offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5354   *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5355   */
5356  struct ieee80211_ema_beacons {
5357  	u8 cnt;
5358  	struct {
5359  		struct sk_buff *skb;
5360  		struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets offs;
5361  	} bcn[];
5362  };
5363  
5364  /**
5365   * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list - EMA beacon template generation
5366   * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5367   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5368   * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
5369   *
5370   * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5371   * but allocates and returns a pointer to list of all beacon templates required
5372   * to cover all profiles in the multiple BSSID set. Each template includes only
5373   * one multiple BSSID element.
5374   *
5375   * Driver must call ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list() to free the memory.
5376   *
5377   * Return: EMA beacon templates of type struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *.
5378   *	%NULL on error.
5379   */
5380  struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *
5381  ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5382  				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5383  				       unsigned int link_id);
5384  
5385  /**
5386   * ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list - free an EMA beacon template list
5387   * @ema_beacons: list of EMA beacons of type &struct ieee80211_ema_beacons pointers.
5388   *
5389   * This function will free a list previously acquired by calling
5390   * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list()
5391   */
5392  void ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list(struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *ema_beacons);
5393  
5394  /**
5395   * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function
5396   * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5397   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5398   * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset.
5399   *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5400   * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length,
5401   *	(including the ID and length bytes!).
5402   *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5403   * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5404   *	that is not associated with AP MLD).
5405   *
5406   * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5407   * obtain the beacon frame.
5408   *
5409   * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5410   * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon
5411   * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly
5412   * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt).
5413   *
5414   * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5415   *
5416   * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5417   */
5418  struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5419  					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5420  					 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length,
5421  					 unsigned int link_id);
5422  
5423  /**
5424   * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function
5425   * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5426   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5427   * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5428   *	that is not associated with AP MLD).
5429   *
5430   * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5431   *
5432   * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5433   */
ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_vif * vif,unsigned int link_id)5434  static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5435  						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5436  						   unsigned int link_id)
5437  {
5438  	return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL, link_id);
5439  }
5440  
5441  /**
5442   * ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn - request mac80211 to decrement the beacon countdown
5443   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5444   *
5445   * The beacon counter should be updated after each beacon transmission.
5446   * This function is called implicitly when
5447   * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the
5448   * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this
5449   * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's beacon countdown.
5450   *
5451   * Return: new countdown value
5452   */
5453  u8 ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5454  
5455  /**
5456   * ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn - request mac80211 to set beacon countdown
5457   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5458   * @counter: the new value for the counter
5459   *
5460   * The beacon countdown can be changed by the device, this API should be
5461   * used by the device driver to update csa counter in mac80211.
5462   *
5463   * It should never be used together with ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(),
5464   * as it will cause a race condition around the counter value.
5465   */
5466  void ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 counter);
5467  
5468  /**
5469   * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch
5470   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5471   *
5472   * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5473   * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5474   * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed.
5475   */
5476  void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5477  
5478  /**
5479   * ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete - find out if countdown reached 1
5480   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5481   *
5482   * This function returns whether the countdown reached zero.
5483   */
5484  bool ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5485  
5486  /**
5487   * ieee80211_color_change_finish - notify mac80211 about color change
5488   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5489   *
5490   * After a color change announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5491   * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5492   * notify mac80211 that the color can be changed
5493   */
5494  void ieee80211_color_change_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5495  
5496  /**
5497   * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template
5498   * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5499   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5500   *
5501   * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5502   * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller.
5503   *
5504   * Can only be called in AP mode.
5505   *
5506   * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error.
5507   */
5508  struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5509  					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5510  
5511  /**
5512   * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template
5513   * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5514   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5515   *
5516   * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to
5517   * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5518   * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used.
5519   *
5520   * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5521   * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit.
5522   *
5523   * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error.
5524   */
5525  struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5526  				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5527  
5528  /**
5529   * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template
5530   * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5531   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5532   * @link_id: If the vif is an MLD, get a frame with the link addresses
5533   *	for the given link ID. For a link_id < 0 you get a frame with
5534   *	MLD addresses, however useful that might be.
5535   * @qos_ok: QoS NDP is acceptable to the caller, this should be set
5536   *	if at all possible
5537   *
5538   * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to
5539   * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5540   * BSSID and address is used.
5541   *
5542   * If @qos_ndp is set and the association is to an AP with QoS/WMM, the
5543   * returned packet will be QoS NDP.
5544   *
5545   * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5546   * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields.
5547   *
5548   * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error.
5549   */
5550  struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5551  				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5552  				       int link_id, bool qos_ok);
5553  
5554  /**
5555   * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
5556   * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5557   * @src_addr: source MAC address
5558   * @ssid: SSID buffer
5559   * @ssid_len: length of SSID
5560   * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs
5561   *
5562   * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5563   * hardware.
5564   *
5565   * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
5566   */
5567  struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5568  				       const u8 *src_addr,
5569  				       const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
5570  				       size_t tailroom);
5571  
5572  /**
5573   * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function
5574   * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5575   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5576   * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5577   * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5578   * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5579   * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame.
5580   *
5581   * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5582   * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5583   * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5584   * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed.
5585   */
5586  void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5587  		       const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5588  		       const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5589  		       struct ieee80211_rts *rts);
5590  
5591  /**
5592   * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame
5593   * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5594   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5595   * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5596   * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5597   *
5598   * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5599   * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5600   * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5601   *
5602   * Return: The duration.
5603   */
5604  __le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5605  			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len,
5606  			      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5607  
5608  /**
5609   * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function
5610   * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5611   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5612   * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5613   * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5614   * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5615   * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame.
5616   *
5617   * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5618   * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5619   * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5620   * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed.
5621   */
5622  void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5623  			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5624  			     const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5625  			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5626  			     struct ieee80211_cts *cts);
5627  
5628  /**
5629   * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame
5630   * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5631   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5632   * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5633   * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5634   *
5635   * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5636   * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5637   * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5638   *
5639   * Return: The duration.
5640   */
5641  __le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5642  				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5643  				    size_t frame_len,
5644  				    const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5645  
5646  /**
5647   * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame
5648   * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5649   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5650   * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on
5651   * @frame_len: the length of the frame.
5652   * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted.
5653   *
5654   * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its
5655   * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps).
5656   *
5657   * Return: The duration.
5658   */
5659  __le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5660  					struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5661  					enum nl80211_band band,
5662  					size_t frame_len,
5663  					struct ieee80211_rate *rate);
5664  
5665  /**
5666   * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames
5667   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5668   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5669   *
5670   * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If
5671   * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast
5672   * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host
5673   * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered
5674   * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame.
5675   *
5676   * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered
5677   * frames are available.
5678   *
5679   * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was
5680   * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus
5681   * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns
5682   * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver
5683   * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to
5684   * use common code for all beacons.
5685   */
5686  struct sk_buff *
5687  ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5688  
5689  /**
5690   * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32
5691   *
5692   * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32.
5693   *
5694   * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5695   * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5696   * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5697   */
5698  void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5699  			       u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5700  
5701  /**
5702   * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key
5703   *
5704   * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken
5705   * from the given packet.
5706   *
5707   * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5708   * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted
5709   *	with this P1K
5710   * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5711   */
ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf * keyconf,struct sk_buff * skb,u16 * p1k)5712  static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5713  					  struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k)
5714  {
5715  	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data;
5716  	const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control);
5717  	u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]);
5718  
5719  	ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k);
5720  }
5721  
5722  /**
5723   * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX
5724   *
5725   * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32
5726   * and transmitter address.
5727   *
5728   * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5729   * @ta: TA that will be used with the key
5730   * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5731   * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5732   */
5733  void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5734  			       const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5735  
5736  /**
5737   * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key
5738   *
5739   * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values
5740   * in the packet.
5741   *
5742   * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5743   * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be
5744   *	encrypted with this key
5745   * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes
5746   */
5747  void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5748  			    struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k);
5749  
5750  /**
5751   * ieee80211_tkip_add_iv - write TKIP IV and Ext. IV to pos
5752   *
5753   * @pos: start of crypto header
5754   * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5755   * @pn: PN to add
5756   *
5757   * Returns: pointer to the octet following IVs (i.e. beginning of
5758   * the packet payload)
5759   *
5760   * This function writes the tkip IV value to pos (which should
5761   * point to the crypto header)
5762   */
5763  u8 *ieee80211_tkip_add_iv(u8 *pos, struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, u64 pn);
5764  
5765  /**
5766   * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter
5767   *
5768   * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5769   * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5770   *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5771   *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5772   * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data
5773   *
5774   * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs
5775   * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done
5776   * by the device and not by mac80211.
5777   *
5778   * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5779   * can be done concurrently.
5780   */
5781  void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5782  			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5783  
5784  /**
5785   * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter
5786   *
5787   * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5788   * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5789   *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5790   *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5791   * @seq: new sequence data
5792   *
5793   * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the
5794   * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK
5795   * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called
5796   * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211.
5797   *
5798   * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5799   * can be done concurrently.
5800   */
5801  void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5802  			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5803  
5804  /**
5805   * ieee80211_remove_key - remove the given key
5806   * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5807   *
5808   * Remove the given key. If the key was uploaded to the hardware at the
5809   * time this function is called, it is not deleted in the hardware but
5810   * instead assumed to have been removed already.
5811   *
5812   * Note that due to locking considerations this function can (currently)
5813   * only be called during key iteration (ieee80211_iter_keys().)
5814   */
5815  void ieee80211_remove_key(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5816  
5817  /**
5818   * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN
5819   * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on
5820   * @keyconf: new key data
5821   *
5822   * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new
5823   * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper
5824   * RX processing, so this function allows setting them.
5825   *
5826   * The function returns the newly allocated key structure, which will
5827   * have similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to
5828   * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an
5829   * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc.
5830   *
5831   * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware
5832   * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK
5833   * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver
5834   * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses
5835   * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part
5836   * of the reconfiguration.
5837   *
5838   * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq()
5839   * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly.
5840   *
5841   * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware,
5842   * then it will attempt to remove it during this call. In many cases
5843   * this isn't what you want, so call ieee80211_remove_key() first for
5844   * the key that's being replaced.
5845   */
5846  struct ieee80211_key_conf *
5847  ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5848  			struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5849  
5850  /**
5851   * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying
5852   * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on
5853   * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association
5854   * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying
5855   * @gfp: allocation flags
5856   */
5857  void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid,
5858  				const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
5859  
5860  /**
5861   * ieee80211_key_mic_failure - increment MIC failure counter for the key
5862   *
5863   * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
5864   * at the same time.
5865   *
5866   * @keyconf: the key in question
5867   */
5868  void ieee80211_key_mic_failure(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5869  
5870  /**
5871   * ieee80211_key_replay - increment replay counter for the key
5872   *
5873   * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
5874   * at the same time.
5875   *
5876   * @keyconf: the key in question
5877   */
5878  void ieee80211_key_replay(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5879  
5880  /**
5881   * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue
5882   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5883   * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5884   *
5885   * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
5886   */
5887  void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5888  
5889  /**
5890   * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue
5891   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5892   * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5893   *
5894   * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
5895   */
5896  void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5897  
5898  /**
5899   * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue
5900   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5901   * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5902   *
5903   * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_queue_stopped.
5904   *
5905   * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise.
5906   */
5907  
5908  int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5909  
5910  /**
5911   * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues
5912   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5913   *
5914   * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_stop_all_queues.
5915   */
5916  void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5917  
5918  /**
5919   * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues
5920   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5921   *
5922   * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_wake_all_queues.
5923   */
5924  void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5925  
5926  /**
5927   * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan
5928   *
5929   * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is
5930   * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify
5931   * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from
5932   * any context, including hardirq context.
5933   *
5934   * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan
5935   * @info: information about the completed scan
5936   */
5937  void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5938  			      struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
5939  
5940  /**
5941   * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan
5942   *
5943   * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the
5944   * driver whenever there are new scan results available.
5945   *
5946   * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
5947   */
5948  void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5949  
5950  /**
5951   * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped
5952   *
5953   * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by
5954   * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task.
5955   * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan
5956   * while associating, for instance.
5957   *
5958   * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
5959   */
5960  void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5961  
5962  /**
5963   * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags
5964   * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have
5965   *	been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware
5966   *	reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new
5967   *	interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they
5968   *	haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
5969   * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all
5970   *	interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
5971   * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE: Iterate only active interfaces (netdev is up).
5972   * @IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER: Skip any interfaces where SDATA
5973   *	is not in the driver.  This may fix crashes during firmware recovery
5974   *	for instance.
5975   */
5976  enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags {
5977  	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL	= 0,
5978  	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL	= BIT(0),
5979  	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE	= BIT(1),
5980  	IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER	= BIT(2),
5981  };
5982  
5983  /**
5984   * ieee80211_iterate_interfaces - iterate interfaces
5985   *
5986   * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5987   * hardware and calls the callback for them. This includes active as well as
5988   * inactive interfaces. This function allows the iterator function to sleep.
5989   * Will iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
5990   *
5991   * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5992   * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5993   * @iterator: the iterator function to call
5994   * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5995   */
5996  void ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
5997  				  void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
5998  						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5999  				  void *data);
6000  
6001  /**
6002   * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces
6003   *
6004   * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6005   * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6006   * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator
6007   * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can
6008   * be used.
6009   * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6010   *
6011   * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6012   * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6013   * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6014   * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6015   */
6016  static inline void
ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,u32 iter_flags,void (* iterator)(void * data,u8 * mac,struct ieee80211_vif * vif),void * data)6017  ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
6018  				    void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
6019  						     struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6020  				    void *data)
6021  {
6022  	ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw,
6023  				     iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE,
6024  				     iterator, data);
6025  }
6026  
6027  /**
6028   * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces
6029   *
6030   * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6031   * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6032   * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6033   * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead.
6034   * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6035   *
6036   * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6037   * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6038   * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6039   * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6040   */
6041  void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6042  						u32 iter_flags,
6043  						void (*iterator)(void *data,
6044  						    u8 *mac,
6045  						    struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6046  						void *data);
6047  
6048  /**
6049   * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx - iterate active interfaces
6050   *
6051   * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6052   * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6053   * This version can only be used while holding the wiphy mutex.
6054   *
6055   * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6056   * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6057   * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6058   * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6059   */
6060  void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6061  					     u32 iter_flags,
6062  					     void (*iterator)(void *data,
6063  						u8 *mac,
6064  						struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6065  					     void *data);
6066  
6067  /**
6068   * ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic - iterate stations
6069   *
6070   * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
6071   * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
6072   * function for them.
6073   * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6074   *
6075   * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6076   * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6077   * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6078   */
6079  void ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6080  				       void (*iterator)(void *data,
6081  						struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
6082  				       void *data);
6083  
6084  /**
6085   * ieee80211_iterate_stations_mtx - iterate stations
6086   *
6087   * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
6088   * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
6089   * function for them. This version can only be used while holding the wiphy
6090   * mutex.
6091   *
6092   * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6093   * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6094   * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6095   */
6096  void ieee80211_iterate_stations_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6097  				    void (*iterator)(void *data,
6098  						     struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
6099  				    void *data);
6100  
6101  /**
6102   * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6103   *
6104   * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue.
6105   * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be.
6106   *
6107   * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6108   * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue
6109   */
6110  void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work);
6111  
6112  /**
6113   * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6114   *
6115   * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211
6116   * workqueue.
6117   *
6118   * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6119   * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue
6120   * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
6121   */
6122  void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6123  				  struct delayed_work *dwork,
6124  				  unsigned long delay);
6125  
6126  /**
6127   * ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer - Refresh a tx agg session timer.
6128   * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6129   * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6130   *
6131   * This function allows low level driver to refresh tx agg session timer
6132   * to maintain BA session, the session level will still be managed by the
6133   * mac80211.
6134   *
6135   * Note: must be called in an RCU critical section.
6136   */
6137  void ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6138  					    u16 tid);
6139  
6140  /**
6141   * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session.
6142   * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6143   * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6144   * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs)
6145   *
6146   * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise
6147   *
6148   * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6149   * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6150   * will be managed by the mac80211.
6151   */
6152  int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid,
6153  				  u16 timeout);
6154  
6155  /**
6156   * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate.
6157   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6158   * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6159   * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6160   *
6161   * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6162   * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called
6163   * from any context.
6164   */
6165  void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6166  				      u16 tid);
6167  
6168  /**
6169   * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session.
6170   * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop
6171   * @tid: the TID to stop BA.
6172   *
6173   * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active
6174   *
6175   * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6176   * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6177   * will be managed by the mac80211.
6178   */
6179  int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid);
6180  
6181  /**
6182   * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate.
6183   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6184   * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6185   * @tid: the desired TID to BA on.
6186   *
6187   * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6188   * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It
6189   * can be called from any context.
6190   */
6191  void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6192  				     u16 tid);
6193  
6194  /**
6195   * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station
6196   *
6197   * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on
6198   * @addr: station's address
6199   *
6200   * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6201   *
6202   * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6203   * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6204   */
6205  struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6206  					 const u8 *addr);
6207  
6208  /**
6209   * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware
6210   *
6211   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6212   * @addr: remote station's address
6213   * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'.
6214   *
6215   * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6216   *
6217   * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6218   * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6219   *
6220   * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get
6221   *      the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'.
6222   *      We can have multiple STA associated with multiple
6223   *      logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another
6224   *      BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first).
6225   *      In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL
6226   *      is not reliable.
6227   *
6228   * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible.
6229   */
6230  struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6231  					       const u8 *addr,
6232  					       const u8 *localaddr);
6233  
6234  /**
6235   * ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs - find STA by link addresses
6236   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6237   * @addr: remote station's link address
6238   * @localaddr: local link address, use %NULL for any (but avoid that)
6239   * @link_id: pointer to obtain the link ID if the STA is found,
6240   *	may be %NULL if the link ID is not needed
6241   *
6242   * Obtain the STA by link address, must use RCU protection.
6243   */
6244  struct ieee80211_sta *
6245  ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6246  				 const u8 *addr,
6247  				 const u8 *localaddr,
6248  				 unsigned int *link_id);
6249  
6250  /**
6251   * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up
6252   * @hw: the hardware
6253   * @pubsta: the station
6254   * @block: whether to block or unblock
6255   *
6256   * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues
6257   * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before
6258   * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be
6259   * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected
6260   * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag.
6261   *
6262   * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free
6263   * manner.
6264   *
6265   * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames
6266   * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not
6267   * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call
6268   * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to
6269   * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the
6270   * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must
6271   * call this function again to unblock the station. That will
6272   * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if
6273   * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also
6274   * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver
6275   * will be notified that the station woke up some time after
6276   * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually
6277   * woke up while blocked or not.
6278   */
6279  void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6280  			       struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block);
6281  
6282  /**
6283   * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP
6284   * @pubsta: the station
6285   *
6286   * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell
6287   * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the
6288   * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead.
6289   * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD.
6290   *
6291   * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must
6292   * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function
6293   * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or
6294   * all non-irqsafe, don't mix!
6295   *
6296   * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no
6297   *     driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if
6298   *     you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history
6299   *     and restore the _irqsafe version!
6300   */
6301  void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6302  
6303  /**
6304   * ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc - ask mac80211 to send NDP with EOSP
6305   * @pubsta: the station
6306   * @tid: the tid of the NDP
6307   *
6308   * Sometimes the device understands that it needs to close
6309   * the Service Period unexpectedly. This can happen when
6310   * sending frames that are filling holes in the BA window.
6311   * In this case, the device can ask mac80211 to send a
6312   * Nullfunc frame with EOSP set. When that happens, the
6313   * driver must have called ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() to
6314   * let mac80211 know that there are no buffered frames any
6315   * more, otherwise mac80211 will get the more_data bit wrong.
6316   * The low level driver must have made sure that the frame
6317   * will be sent despite the station being in power-save.
6318   * Mac80211 won't call allow_buffered_frames().
6319   * Note that calling this function, doesn't exempt the driver
6320   * from closing the EOSP properly, it will still have to call
6321   * ieee80211_sta_eosp when the NDP is sent.
6322   */
6323  void ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, int tid);
6324  
6325  /**
6326   * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates - recalculate aggregate data after a change
6327   * @pubsta: the station
6328   *
6329   * Call this function after changing a per-link aggregate data as referenced in
6330   * &struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates by accessing the agg field of
6331   * &struct ieee80211_link_sta.
6332   *
6333   * With non MLO the data in deflink will be referenced directly. In that case
6334   * there is no need to call this function.
6335   */
6336  void ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6337  
6338  /**
6339   * ieee80211_sta_register_airtime - register airtime usage for a sta/tid
6340   *
6341   * Register airtime usage for a given sta on a given tid. The driver must call
6342   * this function to notify mac80211 that a station used a certain amount of
6343   * airtime. This information will be used by the TXQ scheduler to schedule
6344   * stations in a way that ensures airtime fairness.
6345   *
6346   * The reported airtime should as a minimum include all time that is spent
6347   * transmitting to the remote station, including overhead and padding, but not
6348   * including time spent waiting for a TXOP. If the time is not reported by the
6349   * hardware it can in some cases be calculated from the rate and known frame
6350   * composition. When possible, the time should include any failed transmission
6351   * attempts.
6352   *
6353   * The driver can either call this function synchronously for every packet or
6354   * aggregate, or asynchronously as airtime usage information becomes available.
6355   * TX and RX airtime can be reported together, or separately by setting one of
6356   * them to 0.
6357   *
6358   * @pubsta: the station
6359   * @tid: the TID to register airtime for
6360   * @tx_airtime: airtime used during TX (in usec)
6361   * @rx_airtime: airtime used during RX (in usec)
6362   */
6363  void ieee80211_sta_register_airtime(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6364  				    u32 tx_airtime, u32 rx_airtime);
6365  
6366  /**
6367   * ieee80211_txq_airtime_check - check if a txq can send frame to device
6368   *
6369   * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6370   * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6371   *
6372   * Return true if the AQL's airtime limit has not been reached and the txq can
6373   * continue to send more packets to the device. Otherwise return false.
6374   */
6375  bool
6376  ieee80211_txq_airtime_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6377  
6378  /**
6379   * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device
6380   * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6381   * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6382   * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6383   * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6384   *
6385   * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6386   * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6387   * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device
6388   * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend. Note that due
6389   * to locking reasons, it is also only safe to call this at few
6390   * spots since it must hold the RTNL and be able to sleep.
6391   *
6392   * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order
6393   * in which they were originally installed and handed to the
6394   * set_key callback.
6395   */
6396  void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6397  			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6398  			 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6399  				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6400  				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6401  				      struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6402  				      void *data),
6403  			 void *iter_data);
6404  
6405  /**
6406   * ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu - iterate keys programmed into the device
6407   * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6408   * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6409   * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6410   * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6411   *
6412   * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6413   * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6414   * the device. Note that due to locking reasons, keys of station
6415   * in removal process will be skipped.
6416   *
6417   * This function requires being called in an RCU critical section,
6418   * and thus iter must be atomic.
6419   */
6420  void ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6421  			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6422  			     void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6423  					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6424  					  struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6425  					  struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6426  					  void *data),
6427  			     void *iter_data);
6428  
6429  /**
6430   * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts
6431   * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6432   * @iter: iterator function
6433   * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
6434   *
6435   * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and
6436   * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other
6437   * places while calling into the driver.
6438   *
6439   * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
6440   * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
6441   * removed.
6442   *
6443   * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
6444   * before the restart are considered already present so will be
6445   * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
6446   * or not.
6447   */
6448  void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic(
6449  	struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6450  	void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6451  		     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
6452  		     void *data),
6453  	void *iter_data);
6454  
6455  /**
6456   * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
6457   * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6458   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6459   *
6460   * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
6461   * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate
6462   * information. This function must only be called from within the
6463   * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function
6464   * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return
6465   * %NULL.
6466   *
6467   * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
6468   */
6469  struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6470  					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6471  
6472  /**
6473   * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons
6474   *
6475   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6476   *
6477   * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and
6478   * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the
6479   * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function.
6480   */
6481  void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6482  
6483  /**
6484   * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP
6485   *
6486   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6487   *
6488   * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and
6489   * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver
6490   * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost.
6491   * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated
6492   * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set.
6493   *
6494   * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state,
6495   * without connection recovery attempts.
6496   */
6497  void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6498  
6499  /**
6500   * ieee80211_disconnect - request disconnection
6501   *
6502   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6503   * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired
6504   *
6505   * Request disconnection from the current network and, if enabled, send a
6506   * hint to the higher layers that immediate reconnect is desired.
6507   */
6508  void ieee80211_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool reconnect);
6509  
6510  /**
6511   * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume
6512   *
6513   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6514   *
6515   * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume.
6516   * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the
6517   * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were
6518   * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or
6519   * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume.
6520   *
6521   * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses
6522   * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface
6523   * will still be added as associated first during resume and then
6524   * disconnect normally later.
6525   *
6526   * This function can only be called from the resume callback and
6527   * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it
6528   * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the
6529   * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto).
6530   */
6531  void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6532  
6533  /**
6534   * ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect - disconnect from AP after
6535   * hardware restart
6536   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6537   *
6538   * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after
6539   * hardware restart.
6540   */
6541  void ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6542  
6543  /**
6544   * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring
6545   *	rssi threshold triggered
6546   *
6547   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6548   * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type
6549   * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
6550   * @gfp: context flags
6551   *
6552   * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality
6553   * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform
6554   * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold.
6555   */
6556  void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6557  			       enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
6558  			       s32 rssi_level,
6559  			       gfp_t gfp);
6560  
6561  /**
6562   * ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - inform CQM of beacon loss
6563   *
6564   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6565   * @gfp: context flags
6566   */
6567  void ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, gfp_t gfp);
6568  
6569  /**
6570   * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected
6571   *
6572   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6573   */
6574  void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6575  
6576  /**
6577   * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process
6578   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6579   * @success: make the channel switch successful or not
6580   *
6581   * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel
6582   * and wake up the suspended queues.
6583   */
6584  void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success);
6585  
6586  /**
6587   * ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect - disconnect due to channel switch error
6588   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6589   * @block_tx: if %true, do not send deauth frame.
6590   *
6591   * Instruct mac80211 to disconnect due to a channel switch error. The channel
6592   * switch can request to block the tx and so, we need to make sure we do not send
6593   * a deauth frame in this case.
6594   */
6595  void ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6596  					 bool block_tx);
6597  
6598  /**
6599   * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition
6600   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6601   * @link_id: link ID for MLO, or 0
6602   * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode
6603   *
6604   * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed
6605   * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than
6606   * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth.
6607   */
6608  void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
6609  			    enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode);
6610  
6611  /**
6612   * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start
6613   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6614   */
6615  void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6616  
6617  /**
6618   * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
6619   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6620   */
6621  void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6622  
6623  /**
6624   * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions
6625   *
6626   * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device
6627   * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba
6628   * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs
6629   * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)."
6630   * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and
6631   * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation.
6632   *
6633   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6634   * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid
6635   * @addr: & to bssid mac address
6636   */
6637  void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap,
6638  				  const u8 *addr);
6639  
6640  /**
6641   * ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames - move RX BA window and mark filtered
6642   * @pubsta: station struct
6643   * @tid: the session's TID
6644   * @ssn: starting sequence number of the bitmap, all frames before this are
6645   *	assumed to be out of the window after the call
6646   * @filtered: bitmap of filtered frames, BIT(0) is the @ssn entry etc.
6647   * @received_mpdus: number of received mpdus in firmware
6648   *
6649   * This function moves the BA window and releases all frames before @ssn, and
6650   * marks frames marked in the bitmap as having been filtered. Afterwards, it
6651   * checks if any frames in the window starting from @ssn can now be released
6652   * (in case they were only waiting for frames that were filtered.)
6653   * (Only work correctly if @max_rx_aggregation_subframes <= 64 frames)
6654   */
6655  void ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6656  					  u16 ssn, u64 filtered,
6657  					  u16 received_mpdus);
6658  
6659  /**
6660   * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame
6661   *
6662   * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder
6663   * buffer.
6664   *
6665   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6666   * @ra: the peer's destination address
6667   * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session
6668   * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver
6669   */
6670  void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn);
6671  
6672  /**
6673   * ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl - helper to queue an RX BA work
6674   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6675   * @addr: station mac address
6676   * @tid: the rx tid
6677   */
6678  void ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *addr,
6679  				 unsigned int tid);
6680  
6681  /**
6682   * ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl - start a Rx BA session
6683   *
6684   * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6685   * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6686   * reordering.
6687   *
6688   * Create structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6689   * when they complete AddBa negotiation.
6690   *
6691   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6692   * @addr: station mac address
6693   * @tid: the rx tid
6694   */
ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif * vif,const u8 * addr,u16 tid)6695  static inline void ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6696  						      const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6697  {
6698  	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6699  		return;
6700  	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid);
6701  }
6702  
6703  /**
6704   * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl - stop a Rx BA session
6705   *
6706   * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6707   * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6708   * reordering.
6709   *
6710   * Destroy structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6711   * when they complete DelBa negotiation.
6712   *
6713   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6714   * @addr: station mac address
6715   * @tid: the rx tid
6716   */
ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif * vif,const u8 * addr,u16 tid)6717  static inline void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6718  						     const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6719  {
6720  	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6721  		return;
6722  	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid + IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS);
6723  }
6724  
6725  /**
6726   * ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired - stop a Rx BA session due to timeout
6727   *
6728   * Some device drivers do not offload AddBa/DelBa negotiation, but handle rx
6729   * buffer reording internally, and therefore also handle the session timer.
6730   *
6731   * Trigger the timeout flow, which sends a DelBa.
6732   *
6733   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6734   * @addr: station mac address
6735   * @tid: the rx tid
6736   */
6737  void ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6738  				   const u8 *addr, unsigned int tid);
6739  
6740  /* Rate control API */
6741  
6742  /**
6743   * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo
6744   *
6745   * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for.
6746   * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on.
6747   * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration
6748   * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs
6749   *	to be filled in
6750   * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate
6751   *	which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and
6752   *	used for rate calculations in the mesh network.
6753   * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the
6754   *	RTS threshold
6755   * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission
6756   *	if the selected rate supports it
6757   * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask
6758   * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use)
6759   * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode
6760   */
6761  struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control {
6762  	struct ieee80211_hw *hw;
6763  	struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband;
6764  	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf;
6765  	struct sk_buff *skb;
6766  	struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate;
6767  	bool rts, short_preamble;
6768  	u32 rate_idx_mask;
6769  	u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask;
6770  	bool bss;
6771  };
6772  
6773  /**
6774   * enum rate_control_capabilities - rate control capabilities
6775   */
6776  enum rate_control_capabilities {
6777  	/**
6778  	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW:
6779  	 * Support for extended NSS BW support (dot11VHTExtendedNSSCapable)
6780  	 * Note that this is only looked at if the minimum number of chains
6781  	 * that the AP uses is < the number of TX chains the hardware has,
6782  	 * otherwise the NSS difference doesn't bother us.
6783  	 */
6784  	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW = BIT(0),
6785  	/**
6786  	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER:
6787  	 * mac80211 should start A-MPDU sessions on tx
6788  	 */
6789  	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER = BIT(1),
6790  };
6791  
6792  struct rate_control_ops {
6793  	unsigned long capa;
6794  	const char *name;
6795  	void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6796  	void (*add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, void *priv,
6797  			    struct dentry *debugfsdir);
6798  	void (*free)(void *priv);
6799  
6800  	void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp);
6801  	void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6802  			  struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6803  			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta);
6804  	void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6805  			    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6806  			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6807  			    u32 changed);
6808  	void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6809  			 void *priv_sta);
6810  
6811  	void (*tx_status_ext)(void *priv,
6812  			      struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6813  			      void *priv_sta, struct ieee80211_tx_status *st);
6814  	void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6815  			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6816  			  struct sk_buff *skb);
6817  	void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6818  			 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc);
6819  
6820  	void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta,
6821  				struct dentry *dir);
6822  
6823  	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta);
6824  };
6825  
rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta * sta,enum nl80211_band band,int index)6826  static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6827  				 enum nl80211_band band,
6828  				 int index)
6829  {
6830  	return (sta == NULL || sta->deflink.supp_rates[band] & BIT(index));
6831  }
6832  
6833  static inline s8
rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_sta * sta)6834  rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6835  		  struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
6836  {
6837  	int i;
6838  
6839  	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
6840  		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
6841  			return i;
6842  
6843  	/* warn when we cannot find a rate. */
6844  	WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
6845  
6846  	/* and return 0 (the lowest index) */
6847  	return 0;
6848  }
6849  
6850  static inline
rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_sta * sta)6851  bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6852  			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
6853  {
6854  	unsigned int i;
6855  
6856  	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
6857  		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
6858  			return true;
6859  	return false;
6860  }
6861  
6862  /**
6863   * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver
6864   *
6865   * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass
6866   * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station
6867   * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on
6868   * the most recent rate control module decision.
6869   *
6870   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6871   * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination.
6872   * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station.
6873   */
6874  int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6875  			   struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
6876  			   struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates);
6877  
6878  int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
6879  void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
6880  
6881  static inline bool
conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)6882  conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6883  {
6884  	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
6885  }
6886  
6887  static inline bool
conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)6888  conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6889  {
6890  	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
6891  	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
6892  }
6893  
6894  static inline bool
conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)6895  conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6896  {
6897  	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
6898  	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
6899  }
6900  
6901  static inline bool
conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)6902  conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6903  {
6904  	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40;
6905  }
6906  
6907  static inline bool
conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)6908  conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6909  {
6910  	return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) &&
6911  		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) &&
6912  		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT);
6913  }
6914  
6915  static inline enum nl80211_iftype
ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type,bool p2p)6916  ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p)
6917  {
6918  	if (p2p) {
6919  		switch (type) {
6920  		case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION:
6921  			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT;
6922  		case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP:
6923  			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO;
6924  		default:
6925  			break;
6926  		}
6927  	}
6928  	return type;
6929  }
6930  
6931  static inline enum nl80211_iftype
ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)6932  ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
6933  {
6934  	return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p);
6935  }
6936  
6937  /**
6938   * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif - return HE capabilities for sband/vif
6939   * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
6940   * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
6941   *
6942   * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or %NULL is none found
6943   */
6944  static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)6945  ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6946  				struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
6947  {
6948  	return ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
6949  }
6950  
6951  /**
6952   * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif - return HE 6 GHz capabilities
6953   * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
6954   * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
6955   *
6956   * Return: the 6GHz capabilities
6957   */
6958  static inline __le16
ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)6959  ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6960  			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
6961  {
6962  	return ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
6963  }
6964  
6965  /**
6966   * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif - return ETH capabilities for sband/vif
6967   * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
6968   * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
6969   *
6970   * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or %NULL is none found
6971   */
6972  static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap *
ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)6973  ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6974  				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
6975  {
6976  	return ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
6977  }
6978  
6979  /**
6980   * ieee80211_update_mu_groups - set the VHT MU-MIMO groud data
6981   *
6982   * @vif: the specified virtual interface
6983   * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, otherwise 0
6984   * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
6985   * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
6986   *
6987   * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid and the position and
6988   * membership data is of the correct size and are in the same byte order as the
6989   * matching GroupId management frame.
6990   * Calls to this function need to be serialized with RX path.
6991   */
6992  void ieee80211_update_mu_groups(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
6993  				const u8 *membership, const u8 *position);
6994  
6995  void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6996  				   int rssi_min_thold,
6997  				   int rssi_max_thold);
6998  
6999  void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7000  
7001  /**
7002   * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface
7003   *
7004   * @vif: the specified virtual interface
7005   *
7006   * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid.
7007   *
7008   * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not
7009   * applicable.
7010   */
7011  int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7012  
7013  /**
7014   * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup
7015   * @vif: virtual interface
7016   * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s)
7017   * @gfp: allocation flags
7018   *
7019   * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup().
7020   */
7021  void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7022  				    struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
7023  				    gfp_t gfp);
7024  
7025  /**
7026   * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission
7027   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7028   * @vif: virtual interface
7029   * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver
7030   * @band: the band to transmit on
7031   * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to
7032   *
7033   * Note: must be called under RCU lock
7034   */
7035  bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7036  			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb,
7037  			      int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta);
7038  
7039  /**
7040   * ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap - Sanity-check and parse the radiotap header
7041   *				 of injected frames.
7042   *
7043   * To accurately parse and take into account rate and retransmission fields,
7044   * you must initialize the chandef field in the ieee80211_tx_info structure
7045   * of the skb before calling this function.
7046   *
7047   * @skb: packet injected by userspace
7048   * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
7049   */
7050  bool ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap(struct sk_buff *skb,
7051  				 struct net_device *dev);
7052  
7053  /**
7054   * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state
7055   *
7056   * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change
7057   * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending
7058   *
7059   * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent
7060   *
7061   * private:
7062   *
7063   * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors
7064   * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA
7065   */
7066  struct ieee80211_noa_data {
7067  	u32 next_tsf;
7068  	bool has_next_tsf;
7069  
7070  	u8 absent;
7071  
7072  	u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7073  	struct {
7074  		u32 start;
7075  		u32 duration;
7076  		u32 interval;
7077  	} desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7078  };
7079  
7080  /**
7081   * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE
7082   *
7083   * @attr: P2P NoA IE
7084   * @data: NoA tracking data
7085   * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7086   *
7087   * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors
7088   */
7089  int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr,
7090  			    struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7091  
7092  /**
7093   * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change
7094   *
7095   * @data: NoA tracking data
7096   * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7097   */
7098  void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7099  
7100  /**
7101   * ieee80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation
7102   * @vif: virtual interface
7103   * @peer: the peer's destination address
7104   * @oper: the requested TDLS operation
7105   * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown
7106   * @gfp: allocation flags
7107   *
7108   * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request().
7109   */
7110  void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer,
7111  				 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
7112  				 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
7113  
7114  /**
7115   * ieee80211_reserve_tid - request to reserve a specific TID
7116   *
7117   * There is sometimes a need (such as in TDLS) for blocking the driver from
7118   * using a specific TID so that the FW can use it for certain operations such
7119   * as sending PTI requests. To make sure that the driver doesn't use that TID,
7120   * this function must be called as it flushes out packets on this TID and marks
7121   * it as blocked, so that any transmit for the station on this TID will be
7122   * redirected to the alternative TID in the same AC.
7123   *
7124   * Note that this function blocks and may call back into the driver, so it
7125   * should be called without driver locks held. Also note this function should
7126   * only be called from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7127   *
7128   * @sta: the station to reserve the TID for
7129   * @tid: the TID to reserve
7130   *
7131   * Returns: 0 on success, else on failure
7132   */
7133  int ieee80211_reserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7134  
7135  /**
7136   * ieee80211_unreserve_tid - request to unreserve a specific TID
7137   *
7138   * Once there is no longer any need for reserving a certain TID, this function
7139   * should be called, and no longer will packets have their TID modified for
7140   * preventing use of this TID in the driver.
7141   *
7142   * Note that this function blocks and acquires a lock, so it should be called
7143   * without driver locks held. Also note this function should only be called
7144   * from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7145   *
7146   * @sta: the station
7147   * @tid: the TID to unreserve
7148   */
7149  void ieee80211_unreserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7150  
7151  /**
7152   * ieee80211_tx_dequeue - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7153   *
7154   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7155   * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7156   *	ieee80211_next_txq()
7157   *
7158   * Returns the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
7159   *
7160   * Note that this must be called in an rcu_read_lock() critical section,
7161   * which can only be released after the SKB was handled. Some pointers in
7162   * skb->cb, e.g. the key pointer, are protected by RCU and thus the
7163   * critical section must persist not just for the duration of this call
7164   * but for the duration of the frame handling.
7165   * However, also note that while in the wake_tx_queue() method,
7166   * rcu_read_lock() is already held.
7167   *
7168   * softirqs must also be disabled when this function is called.
7169   * In process context, use ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni() instead.
7170   */
7171  struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7172  				     struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7173  
7174  /**
7175   * ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7176   * (in process context)
7177   *
7178   * Like ieee80211_tx_dequeue() but can be called in process context
7179   * (internally disables bottom halves).
7180   *
7181   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7182   * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7183   *	ieee80211_next_txq()
7184   */
ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq)7185  static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7186  						      struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7187  {
7188  	struct sk_buff *skb;
7189  
7190  	local_bh_disable();
7191  	skb = ieee80211_tx_dequeue(hw, txq);
7192  	local_bh_enable();
7193  
7194  	return skb;
7195  }
7196  
7197  /**
7198   * ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue - mac80211 handler for wake_tx_queue callback
7199   *
7200   * @hw: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7201   * @txq: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7202   *
7203   * Drivers can use this function for the mandatory mac80211 wake_tx_queue
7204   * callback in struct ieee80211_ops. They should not call this function.
7205   */
7206  void ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7207  				    struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7208  
7209  /**
7210   * ieee80211_next_txq - get next tx queue to pull packets from
7211   *
7212   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7213   * @ac: AC number to return packets from.
7214   *
7215   * Returns the next txq if successful, %NULL if no queue is eligible. If a txq
7216   * is returned, it should be returned with ieee80211_return_txq() after the
7217   * driver has finished scheduling it.
7218   */
7219  struct ieee80211_txq *ieee80211_next_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7220  
7221  /**
7222   * ieee80211_txq_schedule_start - start new scheduling round for TXQs
7223   *
7224   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7225   * @ac: AC number to acquire locks for
7226   *
7227   * Should be called before ieee80211_next_txq() or ieee80211_return_txq().
7228   * The driver must not call multiple TXQ scheduling rounds concurrently.
7229   */
7230  void ieee80211_txq_schedule_start(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7231  
7232  /* (deprecated) */
ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,u8 ac)7233  static inline void ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac)
7234  {
7235  }
7236  
7237  void __ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7238  			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq, bool force);
7239  
7240  /**
7241   * ieee80211_schedule_txq - schedule a TXQ for transmission
7242   *
7243   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7244   * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7245   *
7246   * Schedules a TXQ for transmission if it is not already scheduled,
7247   * even if mac80211 does not have any packets buffered.
7248   *
7249   * The driver may call this function if it has buffered packets for
7250   * this TXQ internally.
7251   */
7252  static inline void
ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq)7253  ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7254  {
7255  	__ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, true);
7256  }
7257  
7258  /**
7259   * ieee80211_return_txq - return a TXQ previously acquired by ieee80211_next_txq()
7260   *
7261   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7262   * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7263   * @force: schedule txq even if mac80211 does not have any buffered packets.
7264   *
7265   * The driver may set force=true if it has buffered packets for this TXQ
7266   * internally.
7267   */
7268  static inline void
ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq,bool force)7269  ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7270  		     bool force)
7271  {
7272  	__ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, force);
7273  }
7274  
7275  /**
7276   * ieee80211_txq_may_transmit - check whether TXQ is allowed to transmit
7277   *
7278   * This function is used to check whether given txq is allowed to transmit by
7279   * the airtime scheduler, and can be used by drivers to access the airtime
7280   * fairness accounting without going using the scheduling order enfored by
7281   * next_txq().
7282   *
7283   * Returns %true if the airtime scheduler thinks the TXQ should be allowed to
7284   * transmit, and %false if it should be throttled. This function can also have
7285   * the side effect of rotating the TXQ in the scheduler rotation, which will
7286   * eventually bring the deficit to positive and allow the station to transmit
7287   * again.
7288   *
7289   * The API ieee80211_txq_may_transmit() also ensures that TXQ list will be
7290   * aligned against driver's own round-robin scheduler list. i.e it rotates
7291   * the TXQ list till it makes the requested node becomes the first entry
7292   * in TXQ list. Thus both the TXQ list and driver's list are in sync. If this
7293   * function returns %true, the driver is expected to schedule packets
7294   * for transmission, and then return the TXQ through ieee80211_return_txq().
7295   *
7296   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7297   * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7298   */
7299  bool ieee80211_txq_may_transmit(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7300  				struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7301  
7302  /**
7303   * ieee80211_txq_get_depth - get pending frame/byte count of given txq
7304   *
7305   * The values are not guaranteed to be coherent with regard to each other, i.e.
7306   * txq state can change half-way of this function and the caller may end up
7307   * with "new" frame_cnt and "old" byte_cnt or vice-versa.
7308   *
7309   * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7310   * @frame_cnt: pointer to store frame count
7311   * @byte_cnt: pointer to store byte count
7312   */
7313  void ieee80211_txq_get_depth(struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7314  			     unsigned long *frame_cnt,
7315  			     unsigned long *byte_cnt);
7316  
7317  /**
7318   * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
7319   *
7320   * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function termination.
7321   * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7322   *
7323   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7324   * @inst_id: the local instance id
7325   * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
7326   * @gfp: allocation flags
7327   */
7328  void ieee80211_nan_func_terminated(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7329  				   u8 inst_id,
7330  				   enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
7331  				   gfp_t gfp);
7332  
7333  /**
7334   * ieee80211_nan_func_match - notify about NAN function match event.
7335   *
7336   * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function match. The
7337   * cookie inside the match struct will be assigned by mac80211.
7338   * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7339   *
7340   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7341   * @match: match event information
7342   * @gfp: allocation flags
7343   */
7344  void ieee80211_nan_func_match(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7345  			      struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match,
7346  			      gfp_t gfp);
7347  
7348  /**
7349   * ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for RX.
7350   *
7351   * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7352   * rate information in the RX status struct and the frame length.
7353   *
7354   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7355   * @status: &struct ieee80211_rx_status containing the transmission rate
7356   *          information.
7357   * @len: frame length in bytes
7358   */
7359  u32 ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7360  			      struct ieee80211_rx_status *status,
7361  			      int len);
7362  
7363  /**
7364   * ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for TX.
7365   *
7366   * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7367   * rate information in the TX info struct and the frame length.
7368   *
7369   * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7370   * @info: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
7371   * @len: frame length in bytes
7372   */
7373  u32 ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7374  			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info,
7375  			      int len);
7376  /**
7377   * ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap - enable hardware encapsulation offloading.
7378   *
7379   * This function is used to notify mac80211 that a vif can be passed raw 802.3
7380   * frames. The driver needs to then handle the 802.11 encapsulation inside the
7381   * hardware or firmware.
7382   *
7383   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7384   * @enable: indicate if the feature should be turned on or off
7385   */
7386  bool ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool enable);
7387  
7388  /**
7389   * ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl - Get FILS discovery template.
7390   * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7391   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7392   *
7393   * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7394   *
7395   * Return: FILS discovery template. %NULL on error.
7396   */
7397  struct sk_buff *ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7398  						  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7399  
7400  /**
7401   * ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl - Get unsolicited broadcast
7402   *	probe response template.
7403   * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7404   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7405   *
7406   * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7407   *
7408   * Return: Unsolicited broadcast probe response template. %NULL on error.
7409   */
7410  struct sk_buff *
7411  ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7412  					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7413  
7414  /**
7415   * ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify userland about a BSS color
7416   * collision.
7417   *
7418   * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7419   * @color_bitmap: a 64 bit bitmap representing the colors that the local BSS is
7420   *	aware of.
7421   * @gfp: allocation flags
7422   */
7423  void
7424  ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7425  				      u64 color_bitmap, gfp_t gfp);
7426  
7427  /**
7428   * ieee80211_is_tx_data - check if frame is a data frame
7429   *
7430   * The function is used to check if a frame is a data frame. Frames with
7431   * hardware encapsulation enabled are data frames.
7432   *
7433   * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
7434   */
ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff * skb)7435  static inline bool ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff *skb)
7436  {
7437  	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info = IEEE80211_SKB_CB(skb);
7438  	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (void *) skb->data;
7439  
7440  	return info->flags & IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP ||
7441  	       ieee80211_is_data(hdr->frame_control);
7442  }
7443  
7444  /**
7445   * ieee80211_set_active_links - set active links in client mode
7446   * @vif: interface to set active links on
7447   * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7448   *
7449   * This changes the active links on an interface. The interface
7450   * must be in client mode (in AP mode, all links are always active),
7451   * and @active_links must be a subset of the vif's valid_links.
7452   *
7453   * If a link is switched off and another is switched on at the same
7454   * time (e.g. active_links going from 0x1 to 0x10) then you will get
7455   * a sequence of calls like
7456   *  - change_vif_links(0x11)
7457   *  - unassign_vif_chanctx(link_id=0)
7458   *  - change_sta_links(0x11) for each affected STA (the AP)
7459   *    (TDLS connections on now inactive links should be torn down)
7460   *  - remove group keys on the old link (link_id 0)
7461   *  - add new group keys (GTK/IGTK/BIGTK) on the new link (link_id 4)
7462   *  - change_sta_links(0x10) for each affected STA (the AP)
7463   *  - assign_vif_chanctx(link_id=4)
7464   *  - change_vif_links(0x10)
7465   *
7466   * Note: This function acquires some mac80211 locks and must not
7467   *	 be called with any driver locks held that could cause a
7468   *	 lock dependency inversion. Best call it without locks.
7469   */
7470  int ieee80211_set_active_links(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 active_links);
7471  
7472  /**
7473   * ieee80211_set_active_links_async - asynchronously set active links
7474   * @vif: interface to set active links on
7475   * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7476   *
7477   * See ieee80211_set_active_links() for more information, the only
7478   * difference here is that the link change is triggered async and
7479   * can be called in any context, but the link switch will only be
7480   * completed after it returns.
7481   */
7482  void ieee80211_set_active_links_async(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7483  				      u16 active_links);
7484  
7485  #endif /* MAC80211_H */
7486